U48-4 U55-4 PDF
U48-4 U55-4 PDF
U48-4 U55-4 PDF
KUBOTA EXCAVATOR
U48-4, U55-4
Q General
This section contains information such as engine and equipment ID numbers, general precautions,
maintenance schedules, inspections and maintenance items and special tools.
Q Mechanisms
This section describes the structure of mechanisms and explains their functions.Be sure that you
fully understand this Mechanisms section prior to performing any service work, such as troubleshooting
or when performing any disassembly or assembly work.
Q Service
This section contains information and procedures for performing maintenance on the backhoe, such
as troubleshooting, service specification tables, torque specifications, items to be inspected and
adjusted, disassembly and assembly procedures, as well as precautions, maintenance standard values
and usage limits.
All of the illustrations, specifications and other information in this manual were created based on the
latest model at the time of publication.
Please be aware that changes to the content may be made without prior notice.
NOTE
• Corresponding model list
Machine Model Engine Model
U48-4
For European Union V2607-DI-E3-BH
U55-4
March, 2010
© KUBOTA Corporation 2010
-2
CONTENTS
1. SAFETY FIRST
SAFETY FIRST
• This symbol, the industry's "Safety Alert Symbol", is used throughout this manual and on labels on the
machine itself to warn of the possibility of personal injury. Read these instructions carefully.
• It is essential that you read the instructions and safety regulations before you attempt to repair or use
this unit.
DANGER
• Indicates an imminently hazardous situation which, if not avoided, will result in death or serious injury.
WARNING
• Indicates a potentially hazardous situation which, if not avoided, could result in death or serious injury.
CAUTION
• Indicates a potentially hazardous situation which, if not avoided, may result in minor or moderate
injury.
IMPORTANT
• Indicates that equipment or property damage could result if instructions are not followed.
NOTE
• Gives helpful information.
RY9212007INI0001US0
BEFORE SERVICING AND REPAIRING
• Read all instructions and safety instructions in this
manual and on your engine safety decals.
• Clean the work area and engine.
• Park the machine on a stable and level ground.
• Let the temperature of the engine decrease before
you start a job.
• Stop the engine, then remove the key.
• Disconnect the battery negative cable.
• Hang a "DO NOT OPERATE" tag in the operator
station.
RY9212007INI0002US0
SAFETY STARTING
• Do not do the procedures below when you start the
engine.
– short across starter terminals
– bypass the safety start switch
• Do not make unauthorized modifications to the
engine. This can cause damage and decrease the
engine life.
RY9212007INI0003US0
I-1
AVOID FIRES
• Fuel is very flammable and explosive under some
conditions. Do not smoke or let flames or sparks in
your work area.
• To prevent sparks from an accidental short circuit,
always disconnect the battery negative cable first
and connect it last.
• The battery gas can cause an explosion. Keep the
sparks and open flame away from the top of battery,
especially when you charge the battery.
• Make sure that you do not spill fuel on the engine.
RY9212007INI0005US0
I-2
I-3
2. SAFETY DECALS
The following safety decals are installed on the machine.
If a decal becomes damaged, illegible or is not on the machine, replace it. The decal part number is listed in
the parts list.
RY9212007INI0010US0
DANGER, WARNING AND CAUTION LABELS
(1) Part No. TA040-49580 - Do not touch hot parts such as exhaust etc.
(2) Part No. RC418-57370 - Keep away from fan and fan belt.
(3) Part No. RA028-57240 - Attention to the danger of burning.
RY9212007INI0011US0
I-4
(1) Part No. RD809-57450 - Do not touch hot parts such as exhaust etc.
(2) Part No. RD809-57250 - Do not allow any persons within the working range.
(3) Part No. T1060-30090 - Keep sparks, flame, cigarettes away.
(4) Part No. TD179-30130 - Battery recycle label
(5) Part No. RD359-57840 - Battery cut switch label
RY9212007INI0012US0
I-5
(1) Part No. RD809-57390 - When using a wider or deeper bucket, take good care when swinging or pulling in
the front attachments to make sure that the bucket does not hit the cab.
(2) Part No. RB419-57930 - Label front door lock
(3) Part No. RD809-57430 - Fasten the seatbelt.
(4) Part No. 69198-57840 - Label manual
(5) Part No. RA228-93380 - Anti-theft system
(6) Part No. RD809-57140 - Emergency exit
RY9212052INI0001US0
I-6
(1) Part No. RD809-57950 - For information about loosening the crawler, consult the operating instructions.
(2) Part No. RC108-57960 - Attachment point for lifting gear.
(3) Part No. RD809-57250 - Do not enter the manoeuvring area.
(4) Part No. RB419-57960 - Not an attachment point for lifting gear!
(5) Part No. RD451-57480 - Diesel fuel only, no open fire.
(6) Part No. RA809-57330 - Use the attachment point only for clamping the excavator securely to a transport
vehicle.
(7) Part No. RD359-57260 - Fuel supply label
RY9212052INI0002US0
I-7
I-8
CONTENTS
G-1
2. ENGINE IDENTIFICATION
[1] MODEL NAME AND SERIAL NUMBER
Be sure to check the engine nameplate and serial number when
you wish to consult about the engine.
The model and serial number of the engine need to be checked
prior to servicing the engine or replacing any of its parts.
Q Engine Serial No.
The engine serial number is the numerical ID of the engine and
is printed after the engine's model number.
The year and month of manufacture are indicated as follows
Year Manufactured
Letter or Letter or
Year Year
Number Number
1 2001 F 2015
2 2002 G 2016
3 2003 H 2017
4 2004 J 2018
5 2005 K 2019
6 2006 L 2020
7 2007 M 2021
8 2008 N 2022
9 2009 P 2023
A 2010 R 2024
B 2011 S 2025
C 2012 T 2026
D 2013 V 2027
E 2014
G-2
G-3
3. GENERAL PRECAUTIONS
Whenever performing maintenance on the mini-excavator,
always read the Safety Precautions in this manual and the
Operator's Manual carefully, become familiar with them and perform
the work safely.
Before performing any maintenance on the mini-excavator,
make sure it is sufficiently clean and choose a sufficiently clean
location to perform any disassembly.
Before performing maintenance on the mini-excavator, always
disconnect the negative battery cable first.
Whenever a special tool is required, use the special tool that
KUBOTA recommends. Make any special tools that are not used
very frequently according to the diagrams in this manual.
Always use genuine KUBOTA parts to maintain the
performance and safety characteristics of the mini-excavator.
RY9212001GEG0011US0
Plumber's Tape
• Wrap plumber's tape on the threads before tightening taper
couplings. After wrapping (2 wraps) the plumber's tape, tighten
to the specified torque. Once the coupling is tightened, do not
loosen it as this will cause an oil leak.
(1) Plumber's Tape (4) Gap
(2) External Thread (5) Leave 1 to 2 threads
(3) Internal Thread
RY9212001GEG0012US0
O-Ring
• Clean the groove the O-ring goes in and remove any burrs.
Apply grease on the O-ring when inserting it in the groove.
(Except floating seals)
• When putting the O-ring in the groove, be careful as it is easy at
the very end to twist the O-ring against the inside of the groove.
If it gets twisted, roll it gently with your fingertip to untwist it.
(1) O-ring Groove (4) If the ring touches this corner, it will
(2) O-ring twist
(3) Check for burrs
RY9212001GEG0013US0
Oil Seal
• Do not face the lip of the oil seal in the wrong direction. Face the
main lip toward the material to be sealed.
• After oil seals are replaced, apply grease to the moving parts
around the lip to prevent the dry surfaces from wearing against
each other when the engine is started. If the seal has a dust lip,
fill the gap between the lips with grease.
• As a general rule, use a press to insert the oil seal in place. If
that is not possible, use an appropriate tool to gently and evenly
tap it into place, taking care that it does not go in at a slant.
Press the seal all the way so it seats in the boss.
(1) Gasket A : Air (outside)
(2) Metal Ring B : Hydraulic chamber (inside)
(3) Spring
(4) Main Lip
(5) Grease
(6) Dust Lip
RY9212001GEG0014US0
G-4
Spring Pins
• When driving a spring pin, face the split in the direction that
receives the force, as shown in the diagram.
(1) With lateral movement (2) With rotational movement
RY9212001GEG0017US0
Locktite
• Clean and dry the area where Locktite will be applied with a
solvent so it is free of moisture, oil and dirt.
• Apply locktite all around the threads of the bolt except the first
set of threads at the tip and fill the grooves between the threads.
If the threads or the grooves are large, adjust the amount of
locktite accordingly and apply it all around the bolt hole as well.
(A) Bolt Through-hole (nut) (a) Apply here
(B) Pocket Bolt Hold (b) Do not apply
(capsule shape, etc.) (c) Drip on
RY9212001GEG0018US0
G-5
2. Positioning
• Turn the mouth of the elbow back so it faces the right
direction. (not back over 1 turn)
3. Fasten
• Tighten the lock-nut to the specified torque with a wrench.
(1) Lock-nut (4) Wrench for holding
(2) Washer (5) Hose
(3) Seal (O-ring) (6) Torque wrench for tightening
RY9212001GEG0021US0
G-6
G-7
[1] WIRING
• Tighten wiring terminals securely.
(1) Correct (Tightened securely) (2) Incorrect (Poor contact if loose)
RY9212001GEG0024US0
G-8
• Clamp wiring securely but do not damage wires with the clamp.
(1) Clamp (Spiral clamp around wire) (3) Clamp
(2) Wire (4) Welding Mark
RY9212001GEG0028US0
G-9
[2] FUSES
• Always use fuses of the specified capacity.
Never use over or undersized fuses.
• Never use copper or steel wire in place of a fuse.
• Do not install accessories such as work lights, radios, etc., if
your mini-excavator does not have an auxiliary circuit.
• Do not install accessories as they will exceed the capacity of
fuses.
(1) Fuse (3) Slow-blow Fuse
(2) Fusible Link
RY9212001GEG0032US0
[3] CONNECTOR
• Press the lock to disconnect locking connectors.
(A) Push
RY9212001GEG0033US0
• Straighten bent prongs and make sure none are sticking out or
missing.
• Remove corrosion from terminals with sandpaper.
(1) Missing terminal (3) Sandpaper
(2) Bent Prong (4) Corrosion
RY9212001GEG0035US0
G-10
CAUTION
• Stand at least 2 meters from the mini-excavator and adjust
the nozzle for a wide spray so it does not cause any
damage. If you blast the mini-excavator with water or wash
it from too close a distance,
1. It may cause a fire due to damaged or cuts in the insulation
of electrical wiring.
2. An injury may result if hydraulic oil gushes out under high
pressure, due to damaged hydraulic hoses.
3. It may damage, break or cause parts of the mini-excavator
to fail.
(Ex.)
(1) Stickers or labels may come off
(2) Electrical parts or the engine may fail due to water in them.
(3) Damage glass, resins, etc. or the rubber of oil seals.
(4) Tear off paint or the film from plating
(1) Do not blast with water (A) Blasting
(2) Never wash from too close (B) Wide Spray
(C) Less than 2 m (80 in.)
(D) Over 2 m (80 in.)
RY9212001GEG0038US0
G-11
5. TIGHTENING TORQUES
[1] GENERAL USE SCREWS, BOLTS AND NUTS
Screws, bolts and nuts whose tightening torques are not specified in this Workshop Manual should be
tightened according to the table below.
G-12
(1) Taper
RY9212001GEG0042US0
G-13
(2) Torques of Lock-Nuts for Elbows with Male Seats and Adaptors with
O-rings (Straight Threads)
15.0 to 16.5 N·m
1/8 1.5 to 1.7 kgf·m
11.1 to 12.2 lbf·ft
24.5 to 29.4 N·m
1/4 2.5 to 3.0 kgf·m
18.1 to 21.7 lbf·ft
49.0 to 53.9 N·m
3/8 5.0 to 5.5 kgf·m
36.1 to 39.8 lbf·ft
Torque
58.8 to 63.7 N·m
1/2 6.0 to 6.5 kgf·m
43.4 to 47.0 lbf·ft
117.6 to 127.4 N·m
3/4, 1 12.0 to 13.0 kgf·m
86.8 to 94.0 lbf·ft
220.5 to 230.3 N·m
1-1/4 22.5 to 23.5 kgf·m
162.8 to 170.0 lbf·ft
(1) Taper
RY9212001GEG0044US0
G-14
G-15
G-16
G-17
G-18
Air SP
Type
conditioning AUX1 / AUX2
L O O/O
M – O/O
S – O/–
RY9212052GEG0003US0
G-19
Battery Isolator
G-20
G-21
8. QUALITY SPECIFICATIONS
Machine specification : Auxiliary port1, Wrist rest, Cab, Japan STD-bucket [125 kg (277 lbs) with 2 pins 7 kg
(15.5 lbs)]
Factory Specification
Item Remarks
U48-4 U55-4
Machine size
• Total length (Transport) 5330 ± 107 mm 5500 ± 110 mm
209.8 ± 4.2 in. 216.5 ± 4.3 in.
• Travel speed Rubber F1 2.8 ± 0.3 km/h 2.8 ± 0.3 km/h Traveling stance :
1.74 ± 0.2 mph 1.74 ± 0.2 mph Engine Max. speed
Oil temp. : 50 ± 5 °C
Rubber F2 4.9 ± 0.5 km/h 4.9 ± 0.5 km/h (122 ± 9 °F)
3.04 ± 0.3 mph 3.04 ± 0.3 mph
G-22
Factory Specification
Item Remarks
U48-4 U55-4
Front attachment
• Bucket heaped capacity SAE, JIS 0.16 ± 0.006 m3 0.16 ± 0.006 m3 Slope angle : 1×1
0.2 ± 0.008 yd3 0.2 ± 0.008 yd3
ROPS R
CAB L 71 ± 2 ° 71 ± 2 °
CAB R 54 ± 2 ° 54 ± 2 °
G-23
Factory Specification
Item Remarks
U48-4 U55-4
Front attachment
• Max. dump height ROPS – –
(Arm vertical)
CAB 1425 ± 43 mm 1825 ± 55 mm
56.1 ± 2 in. 71.9 ± 2 in.
G-24
• 2 pump relief 1980 rpm < 1980 rpm < Arm and bucket Slow
(Variable displacement pump) (1 pump relief) operation to relief,
Oil temp. : 50 ± 5 °C
(122 ± 9 °F)
• Blade + 2 pump relief – 1980 rpm < Blade relief, Arm and
(Variable displacement pump) bucket Slow operation
to relief, Oil temp. :
50 ± 5 °C (122 ± 9 °F)
• Idling RPM 1125 ± 75 rpm
Travelling performance
Factory Specification
Item Remarks
U48-4 U55-4
Travel motor block L 0 mm 0 mm 20 deg. slope, 10 min,
performance 0 in. 0 in. Engine stop
Oil temp. : 50 ± 5 °C
R 0 mm 0 mm (122 ± 9 °F)
0 in. 0 in. With parking brake
Max, Traction force F1 3426 kgf < 4140 kgf < Slip 70% theoretical
33.6 kN < 40.6 kN < torque Travel stance,
7554 lbf < 9127 lbf < Oil temp. : 50 ± 5 °C
(122 ± 9 °F)
Rubber 10 to 15 mm 10 to 15 mm
0.39 to 0.59 in. 0.39 to 0.59 in.
G-25
• Up (max. down to max. up) 4.5 ± 0.3 sec. 4.5 ± 0.3 sec.
• Down (max. up to max. down) 4.9 ± 0.3 sec. 4.9 ± 0.3 sec.
Arm speed Crowd 3.2 ± 0.3 sec. 3.2 ± 0.3 sec. Cylinder full stroke
Oil temp. 50 ± 5 °C
Dump 2.8 ± 0.3 sec. 2.8 ± 0.3 sec. (122 ± 9 °F)
Bucket speed Crowd 2.9 ± 0.3 sec. 3.0 ± 0.3 sec. Cylinder full stroke
Oil temp. 50 ± 5 °C
Dump 2.2 ± 0.3 sec. 2.1 ± 0.3 sec. (122 ± 9 °F)
Blade speed Up 1.1 ± 0.3 sec. 1.1 ± 0.3 sec. Cylinder full stroke
(Ground to Oil temp. 50 ± 5 °C
max. up) (122 ± 9 °F)
G-26
Factory Specification
Item Remarks
U48-4 U55-4
Max. digging height radius ROPS – –
G-27
30 ° > 30 ° >
Swivel start-up speed L 2.8 ± 0.3 sec. 2.8 ± 0.3 sec. Front horizontal, 90 °
swivel Bucket load
R 2.8 ± 0.3 sec. 2.8 ± 0.3 sec. heaped [420 kg
(926 lbs) : including
bucket].
Engine Max. Speed
Oil temp. : 50 ± 5 °C
(122 ± 9 °F)
Swing speed (ROPS) L Front horizontal, bucket
crowd with no load.
R Engine Max. speed
Swing speed (CAB) L 5.5 ± 0.5 sec. 6.5 ± 0.5 sec. Oil temp. : 50 ± 5 °C
(122 ± 9 °F)
R 6.4 ± 0.5 sec. 7.9 ± 0.5 sec.
Swing Lock Swivel 10 mm > 90 ° swivel, 100 times
R and L 0.39 in. > actual
Bucket load heaped
[420 kg (926 lbs) :
including bucket].
Oil temp. : 50 ± 5 °C
(122 ± 9 °F)
G-28
G-29
Factory Specification
Item Remarks
U48-4 U55-4
Blade lever Up 1.6 ± 0.5 kgf 1.6 ± 0.5 kgf Up and down
16 ± 5 N 16 ± 5 N Measuring point :
3.6 ± 1.1 lbf 3.6 ± 1.1 lbf 15 mm (0.59 in.) lower
from the lever top
Down 1.6 ± 0.5 kgf 1.6 ± 0.5 kgf
16 ± 5 N 16 ± 5 N
3.6 ± 1.1 lbf 3.6 ± 1.1 lbf
Travel lever (L) Forward 1.9 ± 0.5 ± kgf 1.9 ± 0.5 kgf Measuring point :
19 ± 5 N 19 ± 5 N 20 mm (0.79 in.) lower
4.3 ± 1.1 lbf 4.3 ± 1.1 lbf from the lever top.
Dump 84 ± 10 mm 84 ± 10 mm
3.31 ± 0.4 in. 3.31 ± 0.4 in.
G-30
Factory Specification
Item Remarks
U48-4 U55-4
Bucket lever stroke Crowd 74 ± 10 mm 74 ± 10 mm Measuring point :
2.91 ± 0.4 in. 2.91 ± 0.4 in. The lever top.
Pilot lever with engine
Dump 74 ± 10 mm 74 ± 10 mm Max. speed.
2.91 ± 0.4 in. 2.91 ± 0.4 in.
Bucket lever stroke R 74 ± 10 mm 74 ± 10 mm
2.91 ± 0.4 in. 2.91 ± 0.4 in.
L 74 ± 10 mm 74 ± 10 mm
2.91 ± 0.4 in. 2.91 ± 0.4 in.
Blade lever stroke Up 60 ± 10 mm 60 ± 10 mm Measuring point :
2.36 ± 0.4 in. 2.36 ± 0.4 in. The lever top.
Down 60 ± 10 mm 60 ± 10 mm
2.36 ± 0.4 in. 2.36 ± 0.4 in.
Travel lever stroke (L) Forward 100 ± 10 mm 100 ± 10 mm
3.94 ± 0.4 in. 3.94 ± 0.4 in.
G-31
NOTE
• Above dimensions are based on the machine with KUBOTA original bucket.
• Above dimensions are based on the machine with rubber track.
• Specifications subject to change without notice.
RY9212052GEG0006US0
G-32
RY9212052GEG0007US0
G-33
(To be continued)
G-34
RY9212052GEG0008US0
No. U48-4 U55-4 No. U48-4 U55-4 No. U48-4 U55-4 No. U48-4 U55-4
200 mm 1343 mm 1360 mm 133 mm 145 mm
(1) (6) (11) (16)
7.87 in. 52.87 in. 53.54 in. 5.24 in. 5.71 in.
1250 mm 1370 mm 315 mm 145 mm 61 mm
(2) (7) (12) (17)
49.21 in. 53.94 in. 12.40 in. 5.71 in. 2.40 in.
338 mm 353 mm 335 mm 45 mm 45 mm
(3) (8) (13) (18)
13.31 in. 13.90 in. 13.19 in. 1.77 in. 1.77 in.
217 mm 193 mm 10 mm 45 mm 45 mm
(4) (9) (14) (19)
7.60 in. 7.60 in. 0.39 in. 1.77 in. 1.77 in.
350 mm 335 mm 145 mm 145 mm
(5) (10) (15)
13.78 in. 13.19 in. 5.71 in. 5.71 in.
RY9212052GEG0009US0
G-35
G-36
Remarks
300 mm
(1) Idler O.D.
12.99 in.
52 mm
(2) Guide width
2.05 in.
93 mm
(3) Idler width
3.66 in.
429 mm
(4) Sprocket wheel O.D.
16.89 in.
43 mm
(5) Sprocket wheel width
1.69 in.
G-37
[5] CYLINDER
Max. retraction length (stroke)
Port screw
(1) (2) (3) (4) (5) (6) (7) (8) (9)
size
50 mm 50 mm 70 mm 70 mm 50 mm 90 mm 108 mm 49 mm 50 mm
U48-4 PF 1/2"
1.97 in. 1.97 in. 2.76 in. 2.76 in. 1.97 in. 3.54 in. 4.25 in. 1.03 in. 1.97 in.
Boom
55 mm 55 mm 70 mm 70 mm 55 mm 95 mm 117 mm 55 mm 50 mm
U55-4 PF 1/2"
2.17 in. 2.17 in. 2.76 in. 2.76 in. 2.17 in. 3.74 in. 4.61 in. 2.17 in. 1.97 in.
45 mm 45 mm 70 mm 70 mm 50 mm 80 mm 96 mm 49 mm 50 mm
U48-4 PF 1/2"
1.77 in. 1.77 in. 2.76 in. 2.76 in. 1.97 in. 3.15 in. 3.78 in. 1.03 in. 1.97 in.
Arm
50 mm 50 mm 70 mm 70 mm 55 mm 85 mm 105 mm 55 mm 50 mm
U55-4 PF 1/2"
1.97 in. 1.97 in. 2.76 in. 2.76 in. 2.17 in. 3.35 in. 4.13 in. 2.17 in. 1.97 in.
45 mm 45 mm 60 mm 60 mm 40 mm 70 mm 85 mm 42 mm 39 mm
U48-4 PF 1/2"
1.77 in. 1.77 in. 2.36 in. 2.36 in. 1.57 in. 2.76 in. 3.35 in. 1.65 in. 1.54 in.
Bucket
45 mm 45 mm 60 mm 60 mm 45 mm 75 mm 91 mm 40 mm 40 mm
U55-4 PF 1/2"
1.77 in. 1.77 in. 2.36 in. 2.36 in. 1.77 in. 2.95 in. 3.58 in. 1.57 in. 1.57 in.
45 mm 45 mm 60 mm 60 mm 45 mm 85 mm 102 mm 49 mm 50 mm
U48-4 G 1/4"
1.77 in. 1.77 in. 2.36 in. 2.36 in. 1.77 in. 3.35 in. 4.02 in. 1.03 in. 1.97 in.
Swing
45 mm 45 mm 60 mm 60 mm 50 mm 90 mm 107 mm 49 mm 50 mm
U55-4 G 1/4"
1.77 in. 1.77 in. 2.36 in. 2.36 in. 1.97 in. 3.54 in. 4.21 in. 1.03 in. 1.97 in.
55 mm 55 mm 70 mm 70 mm 55 mm 95 mm 114 mm 55 mm 55 mm
U48-4 G 3/8"
2.17 in. 2.17 in. 2.76 in. 2.76 in. 2.17 in. 3.74 in. 4.49 in. 2.17 in. 2.17 in.
Blade
55 mm 55 mm 70 mm 70 mm 60 mm 110 mm 131 mm 55 mm 56 mm
U55-4 G 3/8"
2.17 in. 2.17 in. 2.76 in. 2.76 in. 2.36 in. 4.33 in. 5.16 in. 2.17 in. 2.20 in.
RY9212052GEG0014US0
G-38
G-39
The above weight list is based on calculation and slightly different from actual ones.
RY9212052GEG0015US0
G-40
*1 : Under very dusty conditions, the air filter and the interior air filter must be cleaned more frequently or replaced.
G-41
The servicing identified with O must be carried after the specified hours of operation after initial operation have been reached.
*1 : Under very dusty conditions, the air filter and the interior air filter must be cleaned more frequently or replaced.
*2 : When using a hydraulic hammer over 20 % → every 800 h.
When using a hydraulic hammer over 40 % → every 400 h.
When using a hydraulic hammer over 60 % → every 300 h.
When using a hydraulic hammer over 80 % → every 200 h.
*3 : Please contact your KUBOTA dealer.
*4 : Earlier if necessary.
*5 : At least annually.
RY9212032GEG0005US0
G-42
CONTENTS
1-S1
Unit KX057-4
mm 92 x 176
(1) Pin diameter x length
in. 3.62 x 6.93
mm 92 x 150
(2) Pin diameter x length
in. 3.62 x 5.91
mm 45 x 158
(3) Pin diameter x length
in. 1.77 x 6.22
mm 45 x 131
(4) Pin diameter x length
in. 1.77 x 5.16
mm 55 x 347
(5) Pin diameter x length
in. 2.17 x 13.66
mm 55 x 165
(6) Pin diameter x length
in. 2.17 x 6.50
mm 55 x 196
(7) Pin diameter x length
in. 2.17 x 7.72
mm 55 x 235
(8) Pin diameter x length
in. 2.17 x 9.25
mm 50 x 196
(9) Pin diameter x length
in. 1.97 x 7.72
mm 50 x 152
(10) Pin diameter x length
in. 1.97 x 5.98
mm 45 x 257
(11) Pin diameter x length
in. 1.77 x 10.12
mm 45 x 257
(12) Pin diameter x length
in. 1.77 x 10.12
mm 45 x 152
(13) Pin diameter x length
in. 1.17 x 5.98
mm 45 x 204
(14) Pin diameter x length
in. 1.77 x 8.03
mm 45 x 204
(15) Pin diameter x length
in. 1.77 x 8.03
mm 45 x 142
(16) Pin diameter x length
in. 1.77 x 5.59
mm 55 x 154
(17) Pin diameter x length
in. 2.17 x 6.06
NOTE
• Service limit of pin and bushing is 1.0 mm (0.04 in.) less and
more than original diameter respectively.
(a) Pin diameter (b) Pin length
RY9212007GEG0012US0
1-S2
2. SWIVEL FRAME
[1] WEIGHT DIASSEMBLY / ASSEMBLY
Removing the bonnet (right)
1. Open the bonnet (right) (4), remove the two snap pins (1), (2),
and separate the gas damper from the bonnet.
2. Slide the bonnet (right) (4) to the front of the body and remove it.
CAUTION
• Have another person help you when removing/attaching
the bonnet (right).
• Bonnet (right) weight : 27 kg (60 lbs)
(1) Snap pin, flat washer (3) Gas damper
(2) Snap pin, flat washer (4) Bonnet (right)
RY9212032MBS0009US0
2. Remove the mounting bracket (4) and four mounting bolts (5) of
the bonnet (rear) and remove the bracket (4).
1-S3
2. Remove the three mounting bolts (3) of the weight, lift slightly
with the crane, slide the weight to the rear, lift the weight and
remove it from the frame.
367.7 to 431.5 N·m
Tightening torque Weight (1) 37.5 to 44.0 kgf·m
271.2 to 318.3 lbf·ft
CAUTION
• When assembling the weight, align the protruding part B of
the weight with the indented part A in the frame and line up
the mounting holes.
(1) Weight A : Indent part in frame
(2) Eyebolt (M24 × P3) B : Protruding part of weight
(3) Bolt (M20×90)
(4) Nylon sling
RY9212052MBS0001US0
1-S4
(1) Fuel tank assembly (5) Plate, assy (8) Plate, assy (a) Tolerance from the frame
(2) Band, assy (fuel tank) (1, fuel tank support) (2, fuel tank support) (swivel) partition plate to
(3) Lock nut (6) Bolt (M10 x 20) (9) Bolt (M10 x 25) band screw part : 20 to
(4) Flat metal washer (7) Flat metal washer (10) Flat metal washer 25 mm, 0.79 to 0.98 in.
RY9212050MBS0001US0
Assembling the fuel hose
(1) Fuel tank assembly (2) Bolt (M10 x 25) (a) Cock closed position (b) Be careful to make sure the
hose does not get caught
between the frame (swivel)
and the fuel tank
RY9212050MBS0002US0
1-S5
1-S6
(1) Drain cock (3) Water separator (5) Fuel filter (7) Fuel cooler
(2) Fuel tank (4) Fuel pump (6) Engine
RY9212052MBS0008US0
1-S7
(1) Hydraulic oil tank (7) Plug (fill) (13) Bolt (M10 x 16) (20) Sealing washer
(2) Cover (tank) (8) O-Ring (14) Plug (G1/4) (21) Flange holder
(3) O-Ring (9) Bolt (M10 x 16) (15) O-Ring (22) Tube (blazer)
(4) Filter (return) (10) Filter, assy (suction) (16) Plug (23) Magnet plug
(5) Stopper (return filter) (11) Pin (suction filter) (17) Sealing washer (24) Sealing washer
(6) Bolt (M8 x 16) (12) O-Ring (18) Filter (blazer) (25) Bolt (M12 x 30)
(19) Metal washer
1-S8
3. Pull up the cover (tank) (1) and remove the filter (return) (6).
(1) Cover (tank) (6) Filter (return)
RY9212001MBS0053US0
4. Clamp in a vice, loosen the set bolt (7), and remove the stopper
(8).
(7) Set bolt (8) Stopper
RY9212001MBS0054US0
CAUTION
• When tightening the filter (return), tighten with the wrench
(1) on the nut (b) shown in the diagram to the left.
If the wrench (1) is placed on the nut on (a) side, the filter
will break.
• Assemble the filter so that opposite sides of the hexagonal
part of the filter fully engages with the flat surfaces of the
stopper (2).
(1) Wrench (9) Filter (return)
(2) Stopper
RY9212001MBS0055US0
1-S9
2. Remove the bolt and the suction filter mounting pin (3).
(3) Pin (suction)
RY9212001MBS0057US0
3. Hold onto the upper part of the filter (support) and remove the
filter (suction) (4) from the tank.
CAUTION
• Remove only the strainer (1) and when replacing with a new
part, set the overall length (A) to 380 mm (15 in.).
16 to 24 N·m
Tightening torque Nut (2) 1.6 to 2.4 kgf·m
12 to 18 lbf·ft
1-S10
1-S11
(5) Assembly of anti vibration support for the hydraulic oil tank
(1) Plate (stay, oil tank) (3) Stay (tank, anti-vibration) (a) Flange bolt (M12 x 20) (c) Bolt (M12 x 30)
(2) Anti-vibration rubber (4) Base (tank, anti-vibration) (b) Bolt (M12 x 60) (d) Bolt (M12 x 30)
(5) Frame (arch)
RY9212001MBS0061US0
Tightening order for each bolt
The tightening order for each bolt is indicated using the letters
(a) through (d) in the diagram to the left.
1-S12
[4] ENGINE
(1) Engine mount
[A] Engine mount structural components
(1) Bracket (1, engine) (6) Support (engine) (11) Bolt (M16 X 70) (15) Pipe clip
(2) Bolt (M12 x 35) (7) Anti-vibration rubber (450) (12) Flat metal washer (16) Flat washer assembly bolt
(3) Bracket (2, engine) (8) Cap (13) Tray (engine) (17) Stay (harness clamp)
(4) Bracket (3, engine) (9) Bolt (M16 x 110) (14) Fuel tube (18) Flat washer assembly bolt
(5) Bracket (4, engine) (10) Collar
Apply thread locking compound (Loctite 271) onto part number (2), (9), (11) and (18).
RY9212050MBS0031US0
1-S13
(2) Muffler
[A] Muffler structural components
(1) Flange (muffler)
(2) Gasket (muffler, NA)
(3) Bolt (M10 x 25)
(4) Gasket (muffler)
(5) Bracket (muffler)
(6) Bolt (M8 x 20)
(7) Pipe (muffler)
(8) Band (flange muffler)
(9) Band (muffler pipe)
(10) Bolt (M8 x 85)
(11) Bolt (M8 x 75)
(12) Flat metal washer
(13) Spring washer
(14) Nut
(15) Insulation (1, muffler)
(16) Insulation (2, muffler)
(17) Wire
RY9212032MBS0027US0
(a) Bolt
(b) Bolt
(c) Bolt
(A) X surface
(B) Y surface
(C) Z surface
Being careful not to dent or deform the tail pipe, tighten with the
following torques.
3.9 to 5.9 N·m
Tightening torque Band (flange muffler) (1) 0.4 to 0.6 kgf·m
2.9 to 4.3 lbf·ft
RY9212032MBS0028US0
1-S14
CAUTION
• Be sure there are not any gaps on the X surface, Y surface,
or Z surface.
2. Tighten the (a) bolt.
3. Tighten the (b) bolt.
4. Tighten the (c) bolt.
(1) Air cleaner, assy (5) Pipe band (9) Frame (2, arch) (a) Place in the frame (arch)
(2) Hose (inlet) (6) Hose (3, inlet) (10) Bolt (M14, arch) guide
(3) Hose clamp (with screw) (7) Indicator (11) Collar (arch) (b) 30 °
(4) Hose (1, inlet) (8) Frame (arch)
RY9212001MBS0082US0
Assembling the Arch
There is a counter bore in the arch mounting area on the swivel
frame and it has a structure where a collar (arch) (4) is inserted and
joined with the arch.
Be careful not to lose the collar (arch) (4) when disassembling
and reassembling and tighten using the following torque.
123.6 to 147.1 N·m
Tightening torque Bolt (3) 12.6 to 15.0 kgf·m
91.17 to 108.4 lbf·ft
1-S15
(4) Radiator
[A] Assembling of the Radiator
(1) Radiator, ASSY (5) Shroud (fan) (9) Hose (drain) (a) Pass through hole
(2) Rubber (radiator mount) (6) Hose (upper, WP) (10) Clamp
(3) Bracket (1, radiator) (7) Hose (lower, WP) (11) Cord band
(4) Bracket (2, radiator) (8) Coupler (drain) (12) Tray (engine oil)
RY9212001MBS0084US0
Assembling the Shroud (fan)
1-S16
(1) Oil cooler (5) Bolt (M8 x 25) (7) Pipe joint (oil cooler, L) (9) Guide (hose, PP)
(2) Bracket (oil cooler) (6) Bolt (M8 x 20) (8) Pipe joint (oil cooler, R) (10) Cooler (fuel)
(3) Bolt (M8 x 20)
(4) Flat metal washer
RY9212032MBS0029US0
Oil cooler assembly procedure
1. Lightly tighten bolts (3), (5), and (6).
2. Tighten bolt (6).
17.7 to 20.6 N·m
Tightening torque Bolt (6) 1.8 to 2.1 kgf·m
13.1 to 15.1 lbf·ft
3. Tighten bolt (3).
9.8 to 11.3 N·m
Tightening torque Bolt (3) 1.0 to 1.15 kgf·m
7.3 to 8.3 lbf·ft
4. Tighten bolt (5).
23.5 to 27.5 N·m
Tightening torque Bolt (5) 2.4 to 2.8 kgf·m
17.4 to 20.2 lbf·ft
1-S17
1-S18
1-S19
1-S20
3. TRACK FRAME
[1] ASSEMBLING OF SWIVEL BEARING
(1) Swivel bearing assembly procedure
1. Component names
No. in Q'ty
Component names
Figure U48-4 U55-4
(1) Bearing (swivel) 1 1
(2) Bolt (M16 x 60) 22 24
(3) Diaphragm spring 44 48
(4) Bolt (M16 x 55) 22 24
2. Assembly position
Mount the inner tire soft zone ('S' mark) (d) on the right side of
the body.
3. Swivel bearing tightening torque
After lightly tightening, tighten to the torque indicated below
from a diagonal angle.
259.9 to 304 N·m
Tightening torque Swivel bearing (1) 26.5 to 31 kgf·m
191.7 to 224 lbf·ft
No. in Size
Figure U48-4 U55-4
A 60 mm, 2.4 in. 60 mm, 2.4 in.
B 50 mm, 2.0 in. 47 mm, 1.8 in.
C 694 mm, 27.3 in. 770 mm, 30.3 in.
D P.C.D. 662 mm, 26.1 in. P.C.D. 742 mm, 29.2 in.
E 605 mm, 23.8 in. 689 mm, 27.1 in.
F P.C.D. 552 mm, 21.7 in. P.C.D. 638 mm, 25.1 in.
G 529 mm, 20.8 in. 610 mm, 24 in.
H P.C.D. 507 mm, 20.0 in. P.C.D. 588 mm, 23.1 in.
I 495.5 mm, 19.5 in. 574 mm, 22.6 in.
RY9212052MBS0005US0
1-S21
CAUTION
• Perform the measurement three times, determine the
average value, and take this as the measured value.
Factory 2.36 mm
(L) : 50 mm (2.0 in.) spec.. 0.1 in.
U48-4
away from swivel race Allowable 4.72 mm
limit 0.19 in.
Factory 1.28 mm
(L) : 20 mm (0.8 in.) spec.. 0.05 in.
U55-4
away from swivel race Allowable 2.56 mm
limit 0.10 in.
1-S22
[2] TRACK
(1) Assembly / disassembly of rubber track
CAUTION
• The pressure in the grease cylinder is high so if loosened quickly, the nipple may pop off and the highly
pressurized grease in the cylinder may fly out so do not get your face near the nipple nor place your body
in front of the nipple and loosen the nipple gradually.
RY9212001MBS0008US0
WARNING
• The excavator is equipped with an overload warning system.
When changing from rubber crawlers to steel crawlers or vice versa it is necessary to change the
overload warning setting.
Overload warning doesn't operate normally, and it could result in death or serious injury if Pre-set code
is not correctly set.
After setting, confirm overload warning operates normally based on Boom Overload Alarm Check
Method. (Refer to "Overload Warning System" at "ELECTRICAL SYSTEM" Section)
RY9212052MBS0013US0
Removing the grease nipple
1. Remove one bolt (2) and then the cover (1).
1-S23
CAUTION
• Make sure to assemble the rubber track in the correct
orientation.
2. With the mini-excavator lifted slightly, hold the rubber track with
your hand on the outside, slowly turn it in the forward direction,
and set it on the stepped area of the front idler.
CAUTION
• Watch carefully to prevent your hands and legs from
getting caught.
• Lower the mini-excavator, drive it backwards to make sure
the tracks are on securely.
RY9212032MBS0034US0
WARNING
• The excavator is equipped with an overload warning system.
When changing from rubber crawlers to steel crawlers or vice versa it is necessary to change the
overload warning setting.
Overload warning doesn't operate normally, and it could result in death or serious injury if Pre-set code
is not correctly set.
After setting, confirm overload warning operates normally based on Boom Overload Alarm Check
Method. (Refer to "Overload Warning System" at "ELECTRICAL SYSTEM" Section)
RY9212052MBS0013US0
1-S24
Loosen track
1. Jack up the body using the front end and blade, expel grease
from inside the grease cylinder, and fully loosen up the track.
When the track loosens up, attach the grease nipple.
RY9212032MBS0008US0
1-S25
DANGER
• Do not place feet under the mini excavator.
• Weight of iron track : approximately 285 kg (628 lbs)
RY9212001MBS0105US0
2. Raise the track using a crane and mesh it with the sprocket
teeth.
(4) Sprocket
RY9212001MBS0107US0
1-S26
2. Using a bar, remove the front idler from the track frame along
with the yoke.
• Front idler assy weight : approximately 46 kg (100 lbs)
(1) Block
RY9212032MBS0035US0
1-S27
(a) Set length for rubber track : 227.5 mm, 8.96 in.
(b) Make sure the cotter pin is set in the groove of
the slotted nut
(c) Set position for iron track specifications
RY9212001MBS0114US0
Iron track specifications
(a) Set length for iron track : 242.5 mm, 9.55 in.
(b) Make sure the cotter pin is set in the groove of
the slotted nut
(c) Set position for rubber track specification
RY9212001MBS0115US0
1-S28
98 to 107.8 N·m
Tightening torque Nipple, assy (6) 10 to 11 kgf·m
73 to 79.5 lbf·ft
RY9212001MBS0117US0
Rubber track specification structural components
1-S29
1-S30
Loosen track
1. Jack up the body using the front end and blade, expel grease
from inside the grease cylinder, and fully loosen up the track.
When the track is loose, attach the grease nipple and place a
block under the track frame.
RY9212032MBS0036US0
1-S31
(1) Track roller, assy (2) Bolt (3) Flat metal washer (a) Less than 1.5 mm (0.06 in.)
(gap between working
surfaces)
RY9212001MBS0120US0
1-S32
Loosen track
1. Jack up the body using the front end and blade, expel grease
from inside the grease cylinder, and fully loosen up the track.
When the track is loose, attach the grease nipple and place a
block under the track frame.
RY9212032MBS0036US0
1-S33
2. Loosen the nut (3) and remove the carrier roller (1).
Carrier weight : approximately 4 kg (9 lbs)
(1) Carrier roller (3) Nut
(2) Block
RY9212032MBS0037US0
1-S34
CONTENTS
1. ENGINE
[1] ENGINE SPECIFICATIONS
U48-4
U48-4 Remarks
(Air conditioner type)
Model V2607-DI-E3-BH-4 V2607-DI-E3-BH-6
Number of cylinder 4
87 x 110 mm
Bore x Stroke
3.43 x 4.33 in.
Displacement 2615 cc, 159.59 in3
29.5 / 2200 kW/rpm 30.0 / 2200 kW/rpm
ISO 9249 NET
Max. output / rpm 40.1 / 2200 PS/rpm 40.8 / 2200 PS/rpm
SAEJ 9249 NET
39.5 / 2200 HP/rpm 40.2 / 2200 HP/rpm
Compression ratio 20
149.6 / 1300 ± 200 N·m 150.3 / 1300 ± 200 N·m
Max. torque/rpm 15.3 / 1300 ± 200 kgf·m 15.3 / 1300 ± 200 kgf·m
110.3 / 1300 ± 200 lbf·ft 110.9 / 1300 ± 200 lbf·ft
687 x 497 x 653 mm
Dimensions : L x W x H
27.0 x 19.6 x 25.7 in.
225 kg 225 kg
Dry weight
496.0 lbs 496.0 lbs
Valve clearance 0.15 mm, 0.01in. Cold condition
Firing sequence 1-3-4-2
Combustion chamber (Direct Injection)
3.20 MPa
Ref. valve at 150 rpm
Compression pressure 32.6 kgf/cm2
starter speed
464 psi
Fan belt Bando RPF3355 Bando RPF3350
234.0 g/kWh 230.1 g/kWh
Fuel consumption ratio 172.1 g/PSh 169.2 g/PSh Net value
0.385 lbs/HPh 0.378 lbs/HPh
Engine speed with idling 1050 to 1200 rpm On the machine
245 to 441 kPa
Engine oil pressure with rated
2.50 to 4.50 kgf/cm2
engine rpm
35.6 to 64.0 psi
Fuel injection pressure 1st stage : 18.6 MPa (190 kgf/cm2, 2700 psi)
1st stage / 2nd stage 2nd stage : 21.6 MPa (220 kgf/cm2, 3130 psi)
0.68 g/kWh
Engine oil consumption ratio 0.50 g/PSh
0.00112 lbs/HPh
Alternator 12 V – 720 w DENSO Co.
Charging current 60 A
Regulation voltage 14.2 ~ 14.8 V
Battery 105D31L
Electrolyte gravity 1.26 ≤
Starter 12 V – 2.0 kW DENSO Co.
Glow plug 0.95 Ω
RY9212052END0001US0
2-G1
U55-4
U55-4 Remarks
(Air conditioner type)
Model V2607-DI-E3-BH-3 V2607-DI-E3-BH-5
Number of cylinder 4
87 x 110 mm
Bore x Stroke
3.43 x 4.33 in.
Displacement 2615 cc, 159.59 in3
33.8 / 2200 kW/rpm 34.3 / 2200 kW/rpm
ISO 9249 NET
Max. output / rpm 46.0 / 2200 PS/rpm 46.6 / 2200 PS/rpm
SAEJ 9249 NET
45.4 / 2200 HP/rpm 46.0 / 2200 HP/rpm
Compression ratio 20
169.7 / 1300 ± 200 N·m 170.4 / 1300 ± 200 N·m
Max. torque/rpm 17.3 / 1300 ± 200 kgf·m 17.4 / 1300 ± 200 kgf·m
125.2 / 1300 ± 200 lbf·ft 125.7 / 1300 ± 200 lbf·ft
687 x 497 x 653 mm
Dimensions : L x W x H
27.0 x 19.6 x 25.7 in.
225 kg 225 kg
Dry weight
496.0 lbs 496.0 lbs
Valve clearance 0.15 mm, 0.01in. Cold condition
Firing sequence 1-3-4-2
Combustion chamber (Direct Injection)
3.20 MPa
Ref. valve at 150 rpm
Compression pressure 32.6 kgf/cm2
starter speed
464 psi
Fan belt Bando RPF3355 Bando RPF3350
232.7 g/kWh 229.3 g/kWh
Fuel consumption ratio 171.2 g/PSh 168.7 g/PSh Net value
0.383 lbs/HPh 0.377 lbs/HPh
Engine speed with idling 1050 to 1200 rpm On the machine
245 to 441 kPa
Engine oil pressure with rated
2.50 to 4.50 kgf/cm2
engine rpm
35.6 to 64.0 psi
Fuel injection pressure 1st stage : 18.6 MPa (190 kgf/cm2, 2700 psi)
1st stage / 2nd stage 2nd stage : 21.6 MPa (220 kgf/cm2, 3130 psi)
0.68 g/kWh
Engine oil consumption ratio 0.50 g/PSh
0.00112 lbs/HPh
Alternator 12 V – 720 w DENSO Co.
Charging current 60 A
Regulation voltage 14.2 ~ 14.8 V
Battery 105D31L
Electrolyte gravity 1.26 ≤
Starter 12 V – 2.0 kW DENSO Co.
Glow plug 0.95 Ω
RY9212052END0003US0
2-G2
(a) Brake Horse Power (kW) (b) Engine Speed (rpm) (c) Torque (N·m) (A) U48-4
(B) U55-4
RY9212052END0002US0
2-G3
[3] DIMENSIONS
Component layout
RY9212050END0003US0
2-G4
2. SPECIAL TOOLS
Diesel Engine Compression Tester
Code No.
• 07909-30208 (Assembly)
• 07909-30934 (A to F)
• 07909-31211 (E and F)
• 07909-31231 (H)
• 07909-31251 (G)
• 07909-31271 (I)
• 07909-31281 (J)
Application
• Use to measure diesel engine compression and diagnostics of
need for major overhaul.
(1) Gauge (7) Adaptor F
(2) L Joint (8) Adaptor G
(3) Adaptor A (9) Adaptor H
(4) Adaptor B (10) Adaptor I
(5) Adaptor C (11) Adaptor J
(6) Adaptor E
RY9212050END0004US0
Oil Pressure Tester
Code No.
• 07916-32032
Application
• Use to measure lubricating oil pressure.
(1) Gauge (5) Adaptor 2
(2) Cable (6) Adaptor 3
(3) Threaded Joint (7) Adaptor 4
(4) Adaptor 1 (8) Adaptor 5
RY9212050END0005US0
2-G5
NOTE
• The following special tools are not provided, make them referring to the figure.
RY9212050END0006US0
Injection Pump Pressure Tester
Application
• Use to check fuel tightness of injection pumps.
Pressure gauge full scale : More than 29.4 MPa
A
(300 kgf/cm2, 4270 psi)
B PF 1/2
C Copper gasket
D Flange (Material Steel)
E Hex. nut 27 mm (1.1 in.) across the plat
F Adhesive application
G Fillet welding on the enter circumference
H Retaining nut
I 17 mm dia. (0.67 in. dia.)
J 8.0 mm dia. (0.31 in. dia.)
K 1.0 mm (0.039 in.)
L 17 mm dia. (0.67 in. dia.)
M 6.10 to 6.20 mm dia. (0.241 to 0.244 in. dia.)
N 8.0 mm (0.31 in.)
O 4.0 mm (0.16 in.)
P 11.97 to 11.99 mm dia. (0.4713 to 0.4720 in. dia.)
Q PF 1/2
R 23 mm (0.91 in.)
S 17 mm (0.67 in.)
T 4.0 mm (0.16 in.)
U 12.00 to 12.02 mm dia. (0.4725 to 0.4732 in. dia.)
V 100 mm (3.94 in.)
W M12 × P1.5
X 5.0 mm (0.20 in.)
RY9212050END0007US0
2-G6
A 3.0 mm dia. (0.12 in. dia.) through hole L 1.0 rad (60 °)
B 17.0 mm (0.669 in.) M 1.0 mm (0.039 in.)
C 16.0 mm dia. (0.630 in. dia.) P0.5 N 17.0 mm (0.669 in.)
D 13.0 mm dia. (0.512 in. dia.) O 47.0 mm (1.85 in.)
E 9.5 mm dia. (0.37 in. dia.) P 15.0 mm (0.591 in.)
F M8 x 1.0 Q 10.0 mm (0.394 in.)
G 6.50 to 6.70 mm dia. (0.256 to 0.263 in. dia.) R 100 mm (3.94 in.)
H 2.12 to 2.18 rad (121 to 125 °) S 65.0 mm (2.56 in.)
I 4.90 to 5.50 mm dia. (0.193 to 0.216 in. dia.) T 190 mm (7.48 in.)
J 0.52 rad (30 °) C1.5 Chamfer 1.5 mm (0.059 in.)
K 5.0 mm (0.20 in.)
2-G7
2-G8
2-G9
2-G10
2-G11
2-G12
2-G13
2-G14
2-G15
2-G16
2-G17
2) Flange
A 35.0 mm (1.38 in.)
B 34.0 mm (1.34 in.)
C 28.0 mm (1.10 in.)
D 27.64 mm (1.088 in.)
E 45.0 mm (1.77 in.)
F 20.5 mm (1.807 in.)
G 16.0 mm (0.630 in.)
H 4.5 mm (0.18 in.)
I 4.5 mm (0.18 in.)
J 7.0 mm dia. (0.28 in. dia.) through hole
K 6.5 mm dia. (0.26 in. dia.) through hole
L 3.2 mm (0.13 in.)
RY9212050END0020US0
Fuel Camshaft Lock Screw (Socket Set Screw Dog Point Type)
Application
• Use to fix the fuel camshaft.
A M8 × Pitch 1.25
B 0.79 rad (45 °)
C 5.0 mm dia. (0.20 in. dia.)
D 4.0 mm (0.16 in.)
E 45 mm (1.8 in.)
F 10 mm (0.39 in.) : Conspicuously Painted
G 5.0 mm (0.20 in.)
2-G18
(1) Material : S43C-D (2) Permanent Magnet : (3) Pin Material : SUM22
8.0 mm dia. (0.31 in. dia.)
Thickness : 3.0 mm (0.12 in.)
RY9212050END0022US0
2-G19
CONTENTS
1. FEATURE
The 07 series DI engine are the vertical type 4-cycle
diesel engine featuring the advanced performances
shown below.
Q New Concept
• The Kubota 07 Series is a totally new concept in
engine design developed with various requirements
necessary for a wide range of industrial applications.
• Kubota's unique cylinder block design was
developed using Kubota's original casting
technology allowing for a larger displacement within
the current 2.4 L compact engine package.
• The improved cooling system with a main water
gallery and water passages between cylinder bores
as a countermeasure against heat load provides
high power density, superior endurance and a
reliable Kubota 07 Series.
• The Kubota 07 Series completes Kubota's seamless
range up to 100 hp.
Q Emissions
• The NEW Kubota 07 Series engines have been
designed to comply with EPA Interim Tier 4 (Option
1) emissions regulations, which are the most
stringent in this size range. The Kubota 07 Series
engines also comply with EU Stage IIIA
requirements. The Kubota 07 Series engines offer
the benefit of one year longer validity than Tier 3.
Therefore, these engines are good through the end
of 2012 in both the North American and European
markets, which would save engineering resources
for the future Tier levels.
• Meeting emission regulations with minimal additional
required devices : NOx is reduced only by
mechanical means such as a compactly designed
cooled exhaust gas recirculation (EGR) system.
Q Clean and Quiet Power
• Kubota's original E-CDIS (Center Direct Injection
System) combustion system, renowned for clean
combustion in the Kubota V3 (DI) Series, has been
renovated. The fuel injection pressure was
increased and the combustion chamber was
redesigned to achieve a 25 % lower particulate
matter (PM) level, resulting in a better condition
when compared to engines that only meet EPA Tier
3 regulations in this class.
• These new engines have been designed to reduce
transmitted vibrations and radiated sound, resulting
in lower noise levels. Operator and environmentally
friendly, the Kubota 07 Series begins a new era of
Kubota's engine design.
RY9212050ENM0001US0
2-M1
2. ENGINE BODY
[1] CYLINDER BLOCK
The 07 series DI engine employs ladder frame
structure type crankcases - the crankcase 1 (1) with
combustion part and the crankcase 2 (2) which supports
the crankcase 1 (1).
The following benefits are in the ladder frame
structure.
1. Minimizing parts.
2. Noise reduction.
3. Reduction of loss and dispersion on friction thanks to
accuracy of axial concentricity.
The cylinder is a linerless type which enables good
cooling operation, less strain and good abrasion
resistance.
(1) Crankcase 1 (2) Crankcase 2
RY9212050ENM0002US0
2-M2
2-M3
2-M4
2-M5
[8] PISTON
Piston's skirt is coated with molybdenum
disulfide+, which reduces the piston slap noise and
thus the entire operating noise.
+Molybdenum disulfide (MoS2)
The molybdenum disulfide (1) serves as a solid
lubricant, like a Graphite or Teflon. This material helps
resist metal wears even with little lube oil.
(1) Molybdenum Disulfide
RY9212050ENM0010US0
2-M6
3. LUBRICATING SYSTEM
[1] OIL COOLER
The 07 series engine has a coolant-cooled oil cooler
that not only cools hot oil, but also warms the cool engine
oil shortly after start up.
As shown in the figure, the oil flows inside the
connected cooler plate, whereas coolant is kept
circulating outside the cooler plate, thereby cooling down
or warming the oil.
(A) Oil Inlet Port (a) Coolant Inlet Port
(B) Oil Outlet Port (b) Coolant Outlet Port
RY9212050ENM0011US0
2-M7
4. COOLING SYSTEM
[1] THERMOSTAT
Conventional thermostatically-controlled valves
(outlet water temperature control type) open against the
flow of coolant. In this design, the pressure (steam
pressure + water pump's discharge pressure) affects the
open/close performance of such valve. In other words,
the valve may be delayed in opening at a preset opening
temperature opening suddenly, above the preset
temperature. This is called the overshoot phenomenon.
The overshoot problem invites the undershoot
phenomenon too. Too much water cooled by the radiator
flows through the water passage, which suddenly closes
the valve below the thermostat's preset valve closing
temperature.
A repeated cycle of such overshoot (3) and
undershoot phenomena is called the water temperature
hunting. This hunting problem may adversely affect the
cooling system parts, and also the engine and its related
components.
To cope with this trouble, the 07 series engine is
equipped with the flow control thermostat. The valve has
a notch (4) to control the coolant flow-rate smoothly in
small steps.
(1) Coolant Temperature (A) Valve Lift Versus Flow-rate
(2) Time (B) Flow-rate
(3) Overshoot (C) At Short Valve Lift
(4) Notch (D) At Medium Valve Lift
(E) At High Valve Lift
(F) Valve Lift
RY9212050ENM0012US0
2-M8
2-M9
5. FUEL SYSTEM
[1] GOVERNOR
The engine employs the separated fuel injection
pump in combination with Kubota's own small
multi-function mechanical governor, which enables more
dependability.
It also employs the torque limiting mechanism to
control the maximum peak torque so that it complies with
the regulations of exhaust gas.
This mechanism maintains engine speed at a
constant level even under fluctuating loads, provides
stable idling and regulates maximum engine speed by
controlling the fuel injection rate.
This engine uses a mechanical governor that
controls the fuel injection rate at all speed ranges (from
idling to maximum speed) by utilizing the balance
between the flyweight's centrifugal force and spring
tension.
A governor shaft for monitoring engine speed is
independent of the injection pump shaft and rotates at
twice the speed of conventional types, providing better
response to load fluctuation and delivering greater
engine output.
RY9212050ENM0014US0
At Start
The stop solenoid (energized-to-run type) is
powered to release the stop lever.
As no centrifugal force is applied to flyweight (2), low
tension of start spring (1) permits control rack to move
the starting position, supplying the amount of fuel
required to start the engine.
(1) Start Spring (2) Flyweight
RY9212050ENM0015US0
2-M10
2-M11
2-M12
2-M13
2-M14
CONTENTS
1. TROUBLESHOOTING.................................................................................................................2-S1
2. SERVICING SPECIFICATIONS ..................................................................................................2-S4
3. TIGHTENING TORQUES..........................................................................................................2-S10
[1] TIGHTENING TORQUES FOR GENERAL USE SCREWS, BOLTS AND NUTS...............2-S10
[2] TIGHTENING TORQUES FOR SPECIAL USE SCREWS, BOLTS AND NUTS.................2-S11
4. CHECKING, DISASSEMBLING AND SERVICING ...................................................................2-S13
[1] CHECKING AND ADJUSTING............................................................................................2-S13
(1) Engine Body ..................................................................................................................2-S13
(2) Lubricating System ........................................................................................................2-S15
(3) Cooling System .............................................................................................................2-S15
(4) Fuel System...................................................................................................................2-S18
(5) Electrical System ...........................................................................................................2-S21
[2] DISASSEMBLING AND ASSEMBLING ..............................................................................2-S25
(1) Draining Oil and Coolant ...............................................................................................2-S25
(2) External Components ....................................................................................................2-S25
(3) Cylinder Head and Valves .............................................................................................2-S26
(4) Thermostat ....................................................................................................................2-S30
(5) Injection Pump Unit .......................................................................................................2-S31
(6) Water Pump and Oil Cooler...........................................................................................2-S41
(7) Front Cover....................................................................................................................2-S41
(8) Flywheel and Timing Gears...........................................................................................2-S42
(9) Piston and Connecting Rod...........................................................................................2-S45
(10)Crankshaft and Crankcase............................................................................................2-S48
(11)Starter ...........................................................................................................................2-S50
(12)Alternator.......................................................................................................................2-S50
[3] SERVICING .........................................................................................................................2-S53
(1) Cylinder Head and Valves .............................................................................................2-S53
(2) Timing Gears .................................................................................................................2-S59
(3) Piston and Connecting Rod...........................................................................................2-S61
(4) Crankshaft .....................................................................................................................2-S65
(5) Cylinder .........................................................................................................................2-S70
(6) Oil Pump........................................................................................................................2-S70
(7) Relief Valve ...................................................................................................................2-S71
(8) Starter............................................................................................................................2-S72
(9) Alternator .......................................................................................................................2-S74
1. TROUBLESHOOTING
Symptom Probable Cause Solution
Engine Does Not No fuel Replenish fuel
Start Air in the fuel system Vent air
Water in the fuel system Change fuel and repair or replace
fuel system
Fuel hose clogged Clean or replace
Fuel filter clogged Replace
Excessively high viscosity of fuel or engine oil at Use specified fuel or engine oil
low temperature
Fuel with low cetane number Use specified fuel
Fuel leak due to loose injection pipe retaining nut Tighten retaining nut
Incorrect injection timing Adjust
Fuel camshaft worn Replace
Injection nozzle clogged Repair or replace
Injection pump malfunctioning Repair or replace
Seizure of crankshaft, camshaft, piston, cylinder Repair or replace
or bearing
Compression leak from cylinder Replace head gasket, tighten
cylinder head screw, glow plug and
nozzle holder
Improper valve timing Correct or replace timing gear
Piston ring and cylinder worn Replace
Excessive valve clearance Adjust
Stop solenoid malfunctioning Replace
Starter Does Not Run Battery discharged Charge
Starter malfunctioning Repair or replace
Key switch malfunctioning Replace
Wiring disconnected Connect
Engine Revolution Is Fuel filter clogged or dirty Replace
Not Smooth Air cleaner clogged Clean or replace
Fuel leak due to loose injection pipe retaining nut Tighten retaining nut
Injection pump malfunctioning Repair or replace
Incorrect nozzle opening pressure Repair or replace
Injection nozzle stuck or clogged Repair or replace
Governor malfunctioning Repair
Either White or Blue Excessive engine oil Reduce to specified level
Exhaust Gas Is Piston ring and cylinder worn or stuck Repair or replace
Observed
Incorrect injection timing Adjust
Either Black or Dark Overload Reduce the load
Gray Exhaust Gas Is Low grade fuel used Use specified fuel
Observed
Fuel filter clogged Replace
Air cleaner clogged Clean or replace
Deficient nozzle injection Repair or replace nozzle
2-S1
2-S2
2-S3
2. SERVICING SPECIFICATIONS
ENGINE BODY
Item Factory Specification Allowable Limit
Compression Pressure 3.20 MPa / 2.20 MPa /
150 min-1 (rpm) 150 min-1 (rpm)
32.6 kgf/cm2 / 22.4 kgf/cm2 /
150 min-1 (rpm) 150 min-1 (rpm)
464 psi / 319 psi /
150 min-1 (rpm) 150 min-1 (rpm)
Variance Among Cylinders – 10 % or less
Valve Clearance (Cold) 0.13 to 0.17 mm –
0.0052 to 0.0068 in.
Top Clearance 0.60 to 0.80 mm –
0.024 to 0.031 in.
Cylinder Head Surface Flatness – 0.05 mm
0.002 in.
Valve Recessing (Intake and Exhaust) 0.65 to 0.85 mm 1.20 mm
0.026 to 0.033 in. 0.0472 in.
Valve Stem to Valve Guide (Intake) Clearance 0.030 to 0.057 mm 0.10 mm
0.0012 to 0.0022 in. 0.0039 in.
2-S4
2-S6
2-S7
Valve Opening 95 °C –
Temperature 203 °F
(Opened
Completely)
FUEL SYSTEM
Item Factory Specification Allowable Limit
Injection Timing V2607-DI-E3B 0.035 to 0.061 rad –
before T.D.C.
(2.0 to 3.5 ° before
T.D.C.)
Pump Element Fuel Tightness – 18.63 MPa
190.0 kgf/cm2
2702 psi
Delivery Valve Fuel Tightness 10 seconds 5 seconds
18.63 → 17.65 MPa 18.63 → 17.65 MPa
190.0 → 180.0 kgf/cm2 190.0 →
2702 → 2560 psi 180.0 kgf/cm2
2702 → 2560 psi
Fuel Injection Nozzle Injection Pressure 18.64 to 20.10 MPa –
(1st stage) 190.0 to 205.0 kgf/cm2
2703 to 2915 psi
2-S8
2-S9
3. TIGHTENING TORQUES
Screws, bolts and nuts must be tightened to the specified torque using a torque wrench, several screws, bolts and
nuts such as those used on the cylinder head must be tightened in proper sequence and the proper torque.
RY9212050ENS0003US0
Indication on
top of nut No-grade or 4T
2-S10
2-S12
2-S13
NOTE
• After adjusting, tighten the lock nut (2) securely.
Valve arrangement
Adjustment cylinder IN. EX.
Location of piston
1st , ,
2-S14
15 to 19 N·m
Tightening torque Oil switch taper screw 1.5 to 2.0 kgf·m
11 to 14 lbf·ft
RY9212050ENS0009US0
2-S15
CAUTION
• When removing the radiator cap, wait at least ten minutes after the engine has stopped and cooled down.
Otherwise, hot water may gush out, scalding nearby people.
RY9212050ENS0012US0
Radiator Cap Air Leakage
1. Set a radiator tester (1) and an adaptor (2) on the radiator cap.
2. Apply the specified pressure of 88 kPa (0.90 kgf/cm2, 13 psi),
and measure the time for the pressure to fall to 59 kPa
(0.60 kgf/cm2, 8.5 psi).
3. If the measurement is less than the factory specification,
replace the radiator cap.
More than 10 seconds
for pressure fall
Pressure falling time Factory specification 88 → 59 kPa
(0.90 → 0.60 kgf/cm2,
13 → 8.5 psi)
NOTE
• The pressure of the leak test is different from each radiator
specification.
Thus, do the leak test, refer to the test pressure of each
radiator specification.
(1) Radiator Tester (2) Adaptor
RY9212050ENS0014US0
2-S16
2-S17
23 to 36 N·m
Injection pipe retaining nut 2.3 to 3.7 kgf·m
17 to 26 lbf·ft
Tightening torque
18 to 20 N·m
Injection pump unit
1.8 to 2.1 kgf·m
mounting nut
13 to 15 lbf·ft
2-S18
NOTE
• Never try to disassemble the injection pump assembly. For
repairs, you are strongly requested to contact a
Kubota-authorized pump service shop.
(1) Injection Pump Pressure Tester (3) Protection Cover for Jetted Fuel
(2) Injection Nozzle
RY9212050ENS0017US0
Fuel Tightness of Delivery Valve
1. Remove the engine stop solenoid.
2. Remove the injection pipes.
3. Install a pressure tester to the fuel injection pump.
4. Install the injection nozzle (2) jetted with the proper injection
pressure to the injection pump pressure tester (1).
5. Run the starter to increase the pressure.
6. Stop the starter when the fuel jets from the injection nozzle (2).
After that, turn the flywheel by the hand and raise the pressure
to approx. 18.63 MPa (190.0 kgf/cm2, 2702 psi).
7. Now turn the flywheel back about half a turn (to keep the plunger
free). Maintain the flywheel at this position and clock the time
taken for the pressure to drop from 18.63 to 17.65 MPa (from
190.0 to 180.0 kgf/cm2, from 2702 to 2560 psi).
8. Measure the time needed to decrease the pressure from 18.63
to 17.65 MPa (from 190.0 to 180.0 kgf/cm2, from 2702 to
2560 psi).
9. If the measurement is less than allowable limit, replace the
pump with new one or repair with a Kubota-authorized pump
service shop.
10 seconds
18.63 → 17.65 MPa
Factory specification
190.0 → 180.0 kgf/cm2
Fuel tightness of delivery 2702 → 2560 psi
valve 5 seconds
18.63 → 17.65 MPa
Allowable limit
190.0 → 180.0 kgf/cm2
2702 → 2560 psi
NOTE
• Never try to disassemble the injection pump assembly. For
repairs, you are strongly requested to contact a
Kubota-authorized pump service shop.
(1) Injection Pump Pressure Tester (3) Protection Cover for Jetted Fuel
(2) Injection Nozzle
RY9212050ENS0018US0
2-S19
CAUTION
• Check the nozzle injection pressure and condition after confirming that there is nobody standing in the
direction the spray goes.
• If the spray from the nozzle directly contacts the human body, cells may be destroyed and blood
poisoning may be caused.
RY9212050ENS0019US0
Nozzle Spraying Condition
1. Attach the injection nozzle to the nozzle tester, and check the
nozzle spraying condition.
2. If the spraying condition is defective, replace the injection
nozzle assembly or repair at Kubota-authorized nozzle service
shop.
(a) Good (b) Bad
RY9212050ENS0020US0
2-S20
2-S21
2-S22
CAUTION
• Secure the starter to prevent it from jumping up and down
while testing the motor.
1. Disconnect the battery negative cable from the battery.
2. Disconnect the battery positive cable from the battery.
3. Disconnect the leads from the starter B terminal.
4. Remove the starter from the engine.
5. Connect a jumper lead from the starter C terminal (1) to the
battery positive terminal (2).
6. Connect a jumper lead momentarily between the starter's body
and the battery negative terminal (3).
7. If the motor does not run, starter is failure.
Repair or replace the starter.
NOTE
• B terminal : It is the terminal which connects the cable from
the battery to the starter.
• C terminal : It is the terminal which connects the cable from
the motor to the magnet switch.
(1) C Terminal (3) Negative Terminal
(2) Positive Terminal
RY9212050ENS0026US0
Magnetic Switch Test
1. Disconnect the battery negative cable from the battery.
2. Disconnect the battery positive cable from the battery.
3. Disconnect the leads from the starter B terminal.
4. Remove the starter from the engine.
5. Connect a jumper lead from the starter S terminal (1) to the
battery positive terminal (2).
6. Connect a jumper lead momentarily between the starter's body
and the battery negative terminal (3).
7. If the pinion gear does not pop out, the magnetic switch is
failure. Repair or replace the starter.
NOTE
• B terminal : It is the terminal which connects the cable from
the battery to the starter.
• S terminal : It is the terminal which connects the cable from
the starter switch to the magnet switch.
(1) S Terminal (3) Negative Terminal
(2) Positive Terminal
RY9212050ENS0027US0
Magnet Switch Continuity Test
1. Check the continuity across the C terminal (1) and the B
terminal (2) with a circuit tester, pushing in the plunger.
2. If not continuous or if a certain value is indicated, replace the
magnet switch.
(1) C Terminal (2) B Terminal
RY9212050ENS0028US0
2-S23
2-S24
Draining Coolant
CAUTION
• Never remove radiator cap while operating or immediately
after stopping. Otherwise, hot water will spout out from the
radiator. Wait for more than ten minutes to cool the
radiator, before opening the cap.
1. Open the radiator drain plug and remove the radiator cap.
2. Remove the radiator hose (1) from engine body.
(1) Radiator Hose
RY9212050ENS0033US0
2-S25
2-S26
2-S27
Cylinder Head
1. Remove the cylinder head screw in the order of (10) to (1), and
remove the cylinder head.
2. Remove the cylinder head gasket.
(When reassembling)
• Replace the head gasket with a new one.
• When mounting the gasket, set it to the knock pin hole. Take
care not to mount it reversely.
• The cylinder head should be free of scratches and dust.
• Take care for handling the gasket not to damage it.
• Install the cylinder head.
• Tighten the cylinder head screw gradually in the order of (1) to
(10) after applying engine oil.
• Be sure to adjust the valve clearance. See the "Valve
Clearance".
• It is not necessary to retighten the cylinder head screw after
running the engine for 30 minutes.
IMPORTANT
• When replacing a piston, piston pin bush, connecting rod
or crankpin bearing, select the cylinder head gasket
thickness to meet with the top clearance refer to the
"Selecting Cylinder Head Gasket".
147 to 156 N·m
Cylinder head mounting
Tightening torque 15.0 to 16.0 kgf·m
screw
109 to 115 lbf·ft
2-S28
2-S29
(4) Thermostat
Thermostat Assembly
1. Remove the thermostat cover mounting screws, and remove
the thermostat cover (1).
2. Remove the thermostat assembly (3).
(When reassembling)
• Attach the thermostat assembly (3) with its hole (4) facing
toward the front cover side.
(1) Thermostat Cover (3) Thermostat Assembly
(2) Thermostat Cover Gasket (4) Hole
RY9212050ENS0042US0
2-S30
2-S31
(1) Injection Pump Unit Mounting Nut (8) Fuel Camshaft Lock Screw
(3) Plug (Socket Set Screw Dog Point Type)
(4) Lubricating Oil Pipe (9) Injection Pump Gear
(5) Injection Pump Unit Support (10) Idle Gear
(7) Injection Timing Mark
RY9212050ENS0043US0
2-S32
2-S33
2-S34
Stop Lever
1. Remove the spring pin (3).
2. Remove the stop lever (2) and the return spring (1).
3. Remove the stop lever shaft (4).
(1) Return Spring (4) Stop Lever Shaft
(2) Stop Lever (5) O-ring
(3) Spring Pin
RY9212050ENS0047US0
2-S35
2-S36
(7) Injection Pump Gear Puller (12) Key Way of Fuel Camshaft
(8) Fuel Camshaft Stopper Mounting (13) Oil Hole
Screw (14) Fuel Camshaft
(9) Fuel Camshaft Stopper (15) Bearing
(10) Fuel Camshaft Bearing Stopper (16) O-ring
(11) Fuel Camshaft Bearing Stopper
Mounting Screw
RY9212050ENS0048US0
2-S37
2-S38
2-S39
2-S40
Oil Cooler
1. Remove the water pipe (2).
2. Remove the oil filter cartridge (1) and the oil cooler joint screw
(3).
3. Remove the oil cooler (4).
64 to 73 N·m
Tightening torque Oil cooler joint screw 6.5 to 7.5 kgf·m
47 to 54 lbf·ft
Relief Valve
1. Remove the relief valve retaining screw (5).
2. Remove the relief valve (2), the spring (3) and the packing (4).
69 to 78 N·m
Tightening torque Relief valve retaining screw 7.0 to 8.0 kgf·m
51 to 57 lbf·ft
2-S41
2-S42
2-S43
2-S44
Tappet
1. Remove the tappets (1) from the tappet bore (2) of the
crankcase 1 (3) using magnetic tool.
(When reassembling)
• Before installing the tappets (1), apply engine oil thinly around
them.
NOTE
• Mark the cylinder number to the tappets (1) to prevent
interchanging.
(1) Tappet (3) Crankcase 1
(2) Tappet Bore
RY9212050ENS0060US0
2-S45
2-S46
2-S47
2-S48
2-S49
(11) Starter
Disassembling Motor
1. Disconnect the solenoid switch (3).
2. Remove the 2 through screws (9) and the 2 brush holder lock
screws. Take out the rear end frame (13) and the brush holder
(12).
3. Disconnect the armature (10) and the yoke (11). Remove also
the ball (7) from the tip of the armature (10).
4. Remove the set of packing (8), the 4 planetary gears (6) and
another packing.
5. Take out the shaft assembly. Take note of the position of the
lever.
IMPORTANT
• Before disconnecting the yoke (11), put tally marks on the
yoke (11) and the front bracket (2).
• Take note of the positions of the set of packing (8) and the
setup bolt.
• Apply grease to the gears, bearings, shaft's sliding part and
ball (7).
NOTE
• Do not damage to the brush and commutator.
(When reassembling)
• Apply grease (DENSO CO. No.50 or equivalent) to the parts
indicated in the figure.
9.8 to 11 N·m
Starter's terminal B
Tightening torque 1.0 to 1.2 kgf·m
mounting nut
7.3 to 8.6 lbf·ft
(12) Alternator
Front Bracket
1. Remove the 4 screws (3).
2. Separate the front bracket (1) and the rear bracket (2) from each
other.
IMPORTANT
• Put a tally line on the front bracket (1) and the rear bracket
(2) for reassembling them later.
(1) Front Bracket (3) Screw
(2) Rear Bracket
RY9212050ENS0066US0
Pulley
1. Hold the rotor (base of the claw) in a vise. Loosen the lock nut
using a M24 box wrench.
58.4 to 78.9 N·m
Tightening torque Alternator pulley nut 5.95 to 8.05 kgf·m
43.1 to 58.2 lbf·ft
RY9212050ENS0067US0
2-S50
Brush
1. When the rotor is detached, the 2 brushes are found to stretch
out of the shaft hole.
RY9212050ENS0069US0
2-S51
2-S52
[3] SERVICING
(1) Cylinder Head and Valves
Top Clearance
1. Remove the cylinder head (remove the cylinder head gasket
completely).
2. Bring the piston to its top dead center, fasten fuse wires (Dia. :
1.5 mm (0.059 in.), long : 5.0 to 7.0 mm (0.20 to 0.28 in.)) (1) to
3 to 4 spots on the piston top with grease so as to avoid the
intake and exhaust valves and the combustion chamber ports.
3. Bring the piston to its middle position, install the cylinder head,
and tighten the cylinder head screws to specification. (Head
gasket must be changed to new one).
4. Turn the crank shaft until the piston exceeds its top dead center.
5. Remove the cylinder head, and measure squeezed fuse wires
(1) for thickness.
6. If the measurement is not within the specified value, check the
oil clearance of the crankpin journal and the piston pin.
0.60 to 0.80 mm
Top clearance Factory specification
0.024 to 0.031 in.
2-S53
Valve Lapping
1. Apply compound evenly to the valve lapping surface.
2. Insert the valve into the valve guide. Lap the valve onto its seat
with a valve flapper or screwdriver.
3. After lapping the valve, wash the compound away and apply oil,
then repeat valve lapping with oil.
4. Apply prussian blue to the contact surface to check the seated
rate. If it is less than 70 %, repeat valve lapping again.
IMPORTANT
• When valve lapping is performed, be sure to check the
valve recessing and adjust the valve clearance after
assembling the valve.
(1) Correct (3) Incorrect
(2) Incorrect
RY9212050ENS0076US0
2-S54
IMPORTANT
• Do not hit the valve guide with a hammer, etc. during
replacement.
(A) When Removing (B) When Installing
RY9212050ENS0078US0
2-S55
35.4 to 35.9 mm
Factory specification
1.40 to 1.41 in.
Free length (B)
34.9 mm
Allowable limit
1.37 in.
2-S56
13.973 to 13.984 mm
Rocker arm shaft O.D. Factory specification
0.55012 to 0.55055 in.
14.000 to 14.018 mm
Rocker arm I.D. for shaft Factory specification
0.55119 to 0.55188 in.
RY9212050ENS0082US0
Oil Clearance between Valve Bridge Arm and Valve Bridge
Shaft
1. Measure the valve bridge arm (1) I.D. with an inside micrometer.
2. Measure the valve bridge shaft (2) O.D. with an outside
micrometer, and then calculate the oil clearance.
3. If the clearance exceeds the allowable limit, replace the valve
bridge arm (1) and measure the oil clearance again. If it still
exceeds the allowable limit, replace also the valve bridge shaft
(2).
0.018 to 0.057 mm
Oil clearance between Factory specification
0.00071 to 0.0022 in.
valve bridge arm and
valve bridge shaft 0.15 mm
Allowable limit
0.0059 in.
8.023 to 8.032 mm
Valve bridge shaft O.D. Factory specification
0.3159 to 0.3162 in.
8.050 to 8.080 mm
Valve bridge arm I.D. Factory specification
0.3170 to 0.3181 in.
2-S57
2-S58
9.965 to 9.980 mm
Tappet O.D. Factory specification
0.3924 to 0.3929 in.
10.000 to 10.015 mm
Tappet bore I.D. Factory specification
0.39370 to 0.39429 in.
0.0460 to 0.136 mm
Factory specification
Backlash between cam 0.00182 to 0.00535 in.
gear and idle gear 0.22 mm
Allowable limit
0.0087 in.
0.0460 to 0.136 mm
Backlash between idle Factory specification
0.00182 to 0.00535 in.
gear and injection pump
gear 0.22 mm
Allowable limit
0.0087 in.
34.959 to 34.975 mm
Idle gear shaft O.D. Factory specification
1.3764 to 1.3769 in.
35.000 to 35.055 mm
Idle gear bushing I.D. Factory specification
1.3780 to 1.3801 in.
RY9212050ENS0089US0
Replacing Idle Gear Bushing
(When removing)
1. Using an idle gear bushing replacing tool, press out the used
bushing. (Refer to "SPECIAL TOOLS" at "GENERAL" section.)
(When installing)
1. Clean a new idle gear bushing and idle gear bore, and apply
engine oil to them.
2. Using an idle gear bushing replacing tool, press in a new
bushing (service parts) to the specified dimension. (See figure.)
(A) When Removing (B) When Installing
RY9212050ENS0090US0
(1) Camshaft
RY9212050ENS0092US0
2-S60
34.934 to 34.950 mm
Camshaft journal 1 O.D. Factory specification
1.3754 to 1.3759 in.
35.000 to 35.025 mm
Cylinder block bore 1 I.D. Factory specification
1.3780 to 1.3789 in.
41.934 to 41.950 mm
Camshaft journal 2 O.D. Factory specification
1.6510 to 1.6515 in.
42.000 to 42.025 mm
Cylinder block bore 2 I.D. Factory specification
1.6536 to 1.6545 in.
2-S61
26.006 to 26.011 mm
Piston pin O.D. Factory specification
1.0239 to 1.0240 in.
26.025 to 26.040 mm
Small end bushing I.D. Factory specification
1.0246 to 1.0252 in.
RY9212050ENS0096US0
Replacing Small End Bushing
(When removing)
1. Press out the used bushing.
(When installing)
1. Clean a new small end bushing and bore, and apply engine oil
to them.
2. Set the guide (4) to the bore of the connecting rod (2).
3. Insert a new first bushing (3) onto the small end bushing
replacing tool. (Refer to "SPECIAL TOOLS" at "GENERAL"
section.)
4. Press-fit it with a press so that the seam (6) of bushing position
as shown in the figure.
5. Turn the connecting rod inside out, and press-fit the second
bushing similarly.
(1) Small End Bushing Replacing Tool (A) When Installing First Bushing
(2) Connecting Rod (B) When Installing Second Bushing
(3) First Bushing (C) 0.26 rad (15 °)
(4) Guide
(5) Second Bushing
(6) Seam
(7) Oil Hole
(8) Mark
RY9212050ENS0097US0
2-S62
0.30 to 0.45 mm
Factory specification
0.012 to 0.017 in.
Second ring
1.25 mm
Allowable limit
0.0492 in.
0.25 to 0.45 mm
Factory specification
0.0099 to 0.017 in.
Oil ring
1.25 mm
Allowable limit
0.0492 in.
RY9212050ENS0099US0
2-S63
0.15 mm
Top ring
0.0059 in.
0.20 mm
Allowable limit Second ring
0.0079 in.
0.15 mm
Oil ring
0.0059 in.
RY9212050ENS0100US0
2-S64
(4) Crankshaft
Crankshaft Side Clearance
1. Set a dial indicator with its tip on the end of the crankshaft (1).
2. Measure the side clearance by moving the crankshaft (1) to the
front and rear.
3. If the measurement exceeds the allowable limit, replace the
thrust bearings.
4. If the same size bearing is out of specifications because of the
crankshaft journal wear, replace it with an oversize one referring
to the table and figure.
0.15 to 0.35 mm
Factory specification
Side clearance of 0.0059 to 0.013 in.
crankshaft 0.50 mm
Allowable limit
0.020 in.
(Reference)
• Oversize dimensions of crankshaft journal.
0.20 mm 0.40 mm
Oversize
0.0079 in. 0.016 in.
37.50 to 37.70 mm 37.60 to 37.80 mm
Dimension A
1.477 to 1.484 in. 1.481 to 1.488 in.
26.20 to 26.25 mm 26.40 to 26.45 mm
Dimension B
1.032 to 1.035 in. 1.040 to 1.041 in.
2.8 to 3.2 mm radius 2.8 to 3.2 mm radius
Dimension C
0.11 to 0.12 in. radius 0.11 to 0.12 in. radius
The crankshaft journal must be fine-finished to higher than Rmax = 0.8S
2-S65
0.011 to 0.058 mm
Oil clearance between Factory specification
0.00044 to 0.0022 in.
crankpin and crankpin
bearing 0.20 mm
Allowable limit
0.0079 in.
IMPORTANT
• STD size crankpin bearing (4).
To replace it with a specific STD service part, make sure the
combination of the crankpin bearing ID color (3) and the
connecting rod mark.
Connecting rod Crankpin bearing
Part
Mark Large-end in. dia. ID color Center wall thick
code
Figure 50.010 to 50.020 mm Blue 1J700- 1.496 to 1.501 mm
(A) 1.9689 to 1.9692 in. (L class) 22310 0.05890 to 0.05909 in.
Without
Figure 50.000 to 50.010 mm 1J700- 1.491 to 1.496 mm
color
(B) 1.9685 to 1.9688 in. 22330 0.05870 to 0.05889 in.
(S class)
(Reference)
• Undersize dimensions of crankpin
0.20 mm 0.40 mm
Undersize
0.0079 in. 0.016 in.
3.3 to 3.7 mm radius 3.3 to 3.7 mm radius
Dimension A
0.13 to 0.14 in. radius 0.13 to 0.14 in. radius
1.0 to 1.5 mm relief 1.0 to 1.5 mm relief
*Dimension B
0.040 to 0.059 in. relief 0.040 to 0.059 in. relief
46.780 to 46.791 mm dia. 46.580 to 46.591 mm dia.
Dimension C
1.8418 to 1.8421 in. dia. 1.8339 to 1.8342 in. dia.
The crankpin must be fine-finished to higher than Rmax = 0.8S
*Holes to be de-burred and edges rounded with 1.0 to 1.5 mm (0.040 to
0.059 in.) relief.
2-S66
0.030 to 0.051 mm
Oil clearance between Factory specification
0.0012 to 0.0020 in.
crankshaft journal and
crankshaft bearing 0.20 mm
Allowable limit
0.0079 in.
(Reference)
• Undersize dimensions of crankshaft journal.
0.20 mm 0.40 mm
Undersize
0.0079 in. 0.016 in.
2.8 to 3.2 mm radius 2.8 to 3.2 mm radius
Dimension A
0.11 to 0.12 in. radius 0.11 to 0.12 in. radius
1.0 to 1.5 mm relief 1.0 to 1.5 mm relief
*Dimension B
0.040 to 0.059 in. relief 0.040 to 0.059 in. relief
72.777 to 72.790 mm dia. 72.577 to 72.590 mm dia.
Dimension C
2.8653 to 2.8657 in. dia. 2.8574 to 2.8578 in. dia.
The crankshaft journal must be fine-finished to higher Rmax = 0.8S
*Holes to be de-burred and edges rounded with 1.0 to 1.5 mm (0.040 to
0.059 in.) relief.
2-S67
2-S68
2-S69
(5) Cylinder
Cylinder Wear
1. Measure the I.D. of the cylinder at the six positions (see figure)
with a cylinder gauge to find the maximum and minimum I.D.'s.
2. Get the difference (Maximum wear) between the maximum and
the minimum I.D.'s.
3. If the wear exceeds the allowable limit, bore and hone to the
oversize dimension. (Refer to "Correcting Cylinder".)
4. Visually check the cylinder wall for scratches. If deep scratches
are found, the cylinder should be bored. (Refer to "Correcting
Cylinder".)
87.000 to 87.022 mm
Factory specification
3.4252 to 3.4260 in.
Cylinder Bore I.D.
87.15 mm
Allowable limit
3.431 in.
2-S70
69 to 78 N·m
Tightening torque Relief valve retaining screw 7.0 to 8.0 kgf·m
51 to 57 lbf·ft
2-S71
(8) Starter
Overrunning Clutch
1. Inspect the pinion for wear or damage.
2. If there is any defect, replace the overrunning clutch assembly.
3. Check that the pinion turns freely and smoothly in the
overrunning direction and does not slip in the cranking direction.
4. If the pinion slips or does not rotate in the both directions,
replace the overrunning clutch assembly.
RY9212050ENS0114US0
0.50 mm
Factory specification
0.020 in.
Mica under cut
0.20 mm
Allowable limit
0.0079 in.
Brush Wear
1. If the contact face of the brush is dirty or dusty, clean it with
emery paper.
2. Measure the brush length (A) with vernier calipers.
3. If the length is less than the allowable limit, replace the yoke
assembly and brush holder.
18.0 mm
Factory specification
0.709 in.
Brush length (A)
11.0 mm
Allowable limit
0.433 in.
2-S72
Armature Coil
1. Check the continuity across the commutator and armature coil
core with an ohmmeter.
2. If it conducts, replace the armature.
3. Check the continuity across the segments of the commutator
with an ohmmeter.
4. If it does not conduct, replace the armature.
Commutator –
Infinity
Resistance Armature coil core
Commutator segment 0Ω
RY9212050ENS0118US0
Field Coil
1. Check the continuity across the lead (1) and brush (2) with an
ohmmeter.
2. If it does not conduct, replace the yoke assembly.
3. Check the continuity across the brush (2) and yoke (3) with an
ohmmeter.
4. If it conducts, replace the yoke assembly.
Lead (1) – Brush (2) 0Ω
Resistance
Brush (2) – Yoke (3) Infinity
2-S73
(9) Alternator
Bearing
1. Check the bearing for smooth rotation.
2. If it does not rotate smoothly, replace it.
RY9212050ENS0120US0
Stator
1. Measure the resistance across each lead of the stator coil with
resistance range of circuit tester.
2. If the measurement is not within factory specification, replace it.
3. Check the continuity across each stator coil lead and core with
resistance range of circuit tester.
4. If infinity is not indicated, replace it.
Resistance Factory specification Less than 1.0 Ω
RY9212050ENS0121US0
Rotor
1. Measure the resistance across the slip rings with an ohmmeter.
2. If the resistance is not the factory specification, replace it.
3. Check the continuity across the slip and core with an ohmmeter.
4. If infinity is not indicated, replace it.
Resistance Factory specification 2.8 to 3.3 Ω
RY9212050ENS0122US0
Slip Ring
1. Check the slip ring for score.
2. If scored, correct with an sand paper or on a lathe.
3. Measure the O.D. of slip ring with vernier calipers.
4. If the measurement is less than the allowable limit, replace it.
22.7 mm
Factory specification
0.894 in.
Slip ring O.D.
22.1 mm
Allowable limit
0.870 in.
RY9212050ENS0123US0
Brush Wear
1. Measure the brush length (A) with vernier calipers.
2. If the measurement is less than allowable limit, replace it.
3. Make sure that the brush moves smoothly.
4. If the brush is defective, replace it.
18.5 mm
Factory specification
0.728 in.
Brush length (A)
5.0 mm
Allowable limit
0.20 in.
2-S74
CONTENTS
3-M1
3-M2
(1) Pump (7) Arm Cylinder (13) Pilot Valve (Blade) (16) Solenoid Valve
(2) Control Valve (8) Bucket Cylinder (14) Pilot Valve (Swing) (AUX1 / AUX2)
(3) Swivel Motor (9) Swing Cylinder (15) Unload Valve (17) AUX1
(4) Swivel Joint (10) Blade Cylinder (18) AUX2
(5) Travel Motor (11) Pilot Valve (Control) (19) Holding Valve
(6) Boom Cylinder (12) Pilot Valve (Travel)
RY9212032HYM0003US0
3-M3
3. FEATURES
[1] ADOPTION OF THE 1-PUMP LS SYSTEM [U48-4]
As all operations in this one-pump system are under LS control, it leads to improved fuel consumption.
RY9212052HYM0027US0
(1) Inlet
(2) AUX2
(3) Blade
(4) Swing
(5) Travel left
LS control section (6) Travel right
(7) Boom
(8) Arm
(9) Backet
(10) Swivel
(11) AUX1
• The pressure regulator valve controls the flow
without affecting the load. The pump uses a
swash-plate to control the required flow volume.
(a) Pump
RY9212052HYM0020US0
3-M4
3-M5
3-M6
3-M7
4. PUMP
[1] PUMP (48-4)
(1) Specifications
(1) Variable pump, piston pump (3) L/S Regulator (6) Port T (8) Port PLS
(first pump) (4) PS Port (section) (7) Port PPS (9) Port PP (pilot)
(2) Gear pump (pilot pump) (5) Port P
(To be continued)
3-M8
RY9212052HYM0001US0
(A) Piston Pump Power (a) Delivery Flow : Q (L/min) (b) Pressure : P (MPa)
Constant Characteristics
Shaft speed : 2200 rpm Total input torque : 115.0 N·m +0 , -3.0
Presure (MPa) Delivery flow (L/min) Presure (MPa) Delivery flow (L/min)
PAo = 0.0 QA0 = 118.8 PB0 = 5.0 QB0 = 117.4 ± 2.5
PA1 = 10.0 QA1 = 115.6 PB1 = 9.0 QB1 = 116.2 ± 2.5
PA2 = 16.0 QA2 = 75.8 PB2 = 11.0 QB2 = 111.6 ± 7.0
PA3 = 24.5 QA3 = 42.8 PB3 = 15.0 QB3 = 80.8 ± 7.0
PB4 = 17.0 QB4 = 69.4 ± 8.0
PB5 = 24.5 QB5 = 42.8 ± 8.0
RY9212052HYM0026US0
3-M9
Configuration Diagram
(1) L/S regulator (3) Swash plate (5) Control pin A (7) Gear Pump
(2) Control pin B (4) Horsepower control spring (6) Horsepower control valve
RY9212001HYM0019US0
3-M10
(2) Components
3-M11
No. Name of part Qty Notes No. Name of part Qty Notes
(1) Case 1 (43) O-Ring 1 JIS B 2401,1B,P14
(2) Bearing 1 (44) O-Ring 2 JIS B 2401,1B,P11
(3) Flange 1 (45) Nut 1
(4) Needle bearing 1 (46) Gear Pump 1
(5) Oil Seal 1 (47) Socket head bolt 4 JIS B 1176,M8x65 L
(6) Snap ring 1 JIS B 2804,42 HOLE (48) Washer 4
JIS B 1176,
(7) Shaft 1 (49) Socket head bolt 6
M12x35 L
(8) Thrust washer 1 (50) Plug 2
(9) Thrust washer 1 (51) Valve ASSY 1 (52)~(65)
(10) Gasket 1 (52) Valve body 1
(11) Pin 3 6x12 L (53) Spool 1
(12) Bushing 2 (54) Bushing 1
(13) Screw 2 (55) Spring seat 1
(14) Valve plate 1 (56) Cap 1
(15) Cylinder block 1 (57) Nut 1
(16) Collar 1 (58) Nut 1
(17) Spring 1 (59) Holder 1
(18) Collar 1 (60) Set screw 1
(19) Snap ring 1 JIS B 2804,48 HOLE (61) Spring 1
(20) Pin 3 (62) O-Ring 1 JIS B 2401,1B,P16
(21) Piston ASSY 9 (63) O-Ring 1 JIS B 2401,1B,P8
(22) Retainer holder 1 (64) Plug 1
(23) Retainer plate 1 (65) O-Ring 1 JIS B 2401,1B,P11
(24) Swash-plate 1 (66) Socket head bolt 4 JIS B 1176,M6x16 L
(25) Pin 1 (67) Stopper 1
(26) Pin 1 (68) Nameplate 1
(27) O-Ring 6 JIS B 2401,1B,P8 (69) Drive screw 2
(28) Plug 17 (70) Shipping plug 2 PF1/4
(29) Orifice 1 (71) Shipping plug 1 PF3/4
(30) Pin 1 (72) O-Ring 1
(31) Spring 1 (73) Pin 1
(32) Spring 1 (74) O-Ring 1 JIS B 2401,1B,P3
(33) Spring seat 2 (75) Pin 1
(34) Valve ASSY 1 (35)~(43) (76) Shipping plug 1 PF3/8
(35) Spool 1 (77) O-Ring 1
(36) Valve sleeve 1 (78) Orifice 1
(37) Servo piston 1 (79) O-Ring 1
(38) O-Ring 1 JIS B 2401,1B,P8 (80) Shipping plate 1
(39) O-Ring 1 (81) Shipping plug 1 PT1/4
(40) Pin 1 (82) Plug 1
(41) Collar 1 (83) O-Ring 1
(42) Plug 1 PF3/8
RY9212001HYM0020US0
3-M12
3-M13
(1) Piston (4) Swash plate (7) Discharge port A : Discharge side
(2) Retainer plate (5) Cylinder block (8) Suction port B : Suction side
(3) Shoe (6) Valve plate
There are nine pistons(1) built into the cylinder block(5) and it is coupled to the axle via a spline.
Also, one end of the cylinder block is in contact with a valve plate (6), which has two half-moon shaped ports
(kidney ports); these two kidney ports are connected to suction and discharge ports respectively, so when the cylinder
block rotates, the pistons are connected to the passage on the suction side for an interval of 180 degrees and to the
discharge side for the remaining interval.
The shoes(3) are crimped so they can rotate freely against the ball on the end of the piston, and the retainer plate
(2) presses them against the swash-plate(4).
As a result, the shoes are always in contact with the swash-plate as it moves, so as the angle of the swash-plate
changes, that translates into changes in the stroke of the piston and ultimately alters the amount of discharge from
the pump.
As a result of the cylinder block rotation, the side that is pressed into the cylinder block by the piston via the
swash-plate is the discharge path.
At that point, the compressed chambers of the cylinder block are connected to the kidney ports on the discharge
side A and the side where the pistons are being withdrawn become the suction path and are connected to the suction
side kidney port.
As a consequence, during the interval of one revolution of the cylinder block, each piston alternately provides
suction at the suction port and then discharge at the discharge port. Thus smooth pump operation is achieved by
having nine pistons constantly alternating between suction and discharge.
RY9212001HYM0022US0
3-M14
(1) Discharge pressure P (3) Horsepower control spool (5) Horsepower control valve (7) Swash plate
(2) Control pin A (4) Control pin B (6) Horsepower control spring
The discharge pressure (1) from the piston pump is guided to control pin A (2) via oil passages inside the case.
The pressure guided to control pin A produces a bias pressure equivalent to the pressure P against the swash-plate,
thus pressuring the swash-plate. When pressure P is low, the horsepower control spool (3) is positioned at the far
left, thus connecting control pin B (4) to the tank via the horsepower control spool, so there is no force on control pin
B, which results in the maximum swash-plate tilt angle and discharge flow.
RY9212001HYM0024US0
3-M15
(1) Discharge pressure P (3) Horsepower control spool (5) Horsepower control valve (9) Reaction pin
(2) Control pin A (4) Control pin B (6) Horsepower control spring
When the piston pump discharge pressure P (1) rises due to the load, the horsepower control spool (3) in the
middle of the diagram moves to the right. This connects discharge pressure P to control pin B (4), creating pressure
on control pin B and thus reducing the swash-plate tilt angle and reducing discharge flow. The pump discharge
pressure P is also connected to control pin A (2), but due to the difference in surface area, the swash-plate tilt angle
is reduced. When the swash-plate tilt angle is reduced, the horsepower control spool is moved back to the left by the
horsepower control springs (6), cutting off the connection between discharge pressure P and control pin B, and this
results in a balance of pressure.
RY9212001HYM0025US0
[D] LS Control
1. LS Control
LS control supplies the pressure and flow needed for
a given load by controlling the pump's discharge
pressure and flow so that pump discharge pressure PPS
= load pressure PLS + spring pressure.
(10) Spring (12) L/S regulator
(11) Spool
RY9212001HYM0004US0
3-M16
3-M17
3-M18
(1) Variable Pump (piston pump) (3) Gear pump (pilot pump) (6) P1 Port (9) Port T
(P1, P2) (4) L/S Regulator (7) P2 Port (10) PPS Port
(2) Gear Pump P3 (5) PS Port (section) (8) P3 Port (11) PLS Port
RY9212032HYM0007US0
3-M19
Remarks
Manufacturer KYB Co.,Ltd.
Model PSVL2-27CG
Rated pump rpm 2200 rpm
Main relief 27.4 MPa
pressure 280 kgf/cm2
a LS 3983 psi
Main relief 26.5 MPa
pressure 270 kgf/cm2 at travel open
a TR/TL 3843 psi
Rated load pressure Main relief 19.1 MPa
pressure 195 kgf/cm2
a P3 2770 psi
Pilot
3.92 MPa
primary
40 kgf/cm2
pressure
569 psi
a Pp
Main pump 25.5 / 25.5 cc/rev Split flow of variable
P1/P2 1.56 / 1.56 cu.in./rev displacement piston pump
Main pump 16.8 cc/rev
Theoretical discharge capacity Gear pump
P3 1.03 cu.in./rev
Pilot pump 7.1 cc/rev
Gear pump
Pp 0.43 cu.in./rev
Main pump 56.1 / 56.1 L/min
P1/P2 14.82 / 14.82 USGPM
Main pump 37.0 L/min
Theoretical discharge capacity
P3 9.78 USGPM
Pilot pump 15.6 L/min
Pp 4.12 USGPM
1.65 MPa Engine rpm propotional control
LS control
Differential pressure 16.8 kgf/cm2 with P4, Idling / Rated = about
valve
239 psi 50 - 70 %
22.9 L/min
Standby flow rate
6.04 USGPM
PC horsepower control valve : With P3 horsepower shift
Swash plate control aided by self-tilting moment (Small piston
Horsepower control
deleted.)
P1 + P2 pressure : Average pressure by orifice
Bearing : Cradle
Structure Shoe plate : Spherical
Large-diameter piston (with shoe)
(To be continued)
3-M20
(1) P3 = 2 MPa, 21 kgf/cm2, (2) P3 = 19.1 MPa, 195 kgf/cm2, (A) Piston Pump Power (a) Delivery Flow : Q1+Q2
291 psi 2770 psi Constant Characteristics (L/min)
(b) Pressure : P1 = P2 (MPa)
RY9212050HYM0028US0
Diagram of Hydraulic Circuit
3-M21
(1) L/S Regulator (3) Swash plate (5) Control pin A (7) Gear Pump
(2) Control pin B (4) Horsepower control spring (6) Horsepower control valve
RY9212001HYM0032US0
3-M22
(2) Components
3-M23
No. Name of part Q'ty Notes No. Name of part Q'ty Notes
(1) Case 1 (46) Washer 2 JIS B 1256,8
JIS B 1176,
(2) Bearing 1 (47) Socket head bolt 6
M12x35 L
(3) Flange 1 (48) Plug 6
(4) Needle bearing 1 (49) Valve ASSY 1 (50) to (63)
(5) Oil Seal 1 (50) Valve body 1
JIS B 2804, 42
(6) Snap ring 1 (51) Spool 1
HOLE
(7) Shaft 1 (52) Bushing 1
(8) Thrust washer 1 (53) Spring seat 1
(9) Thrust washer 1 (54) Cap 1
(10) Gasket 1 (55) Nut 1
(11) Pin 3 6x12 (56) Nut 1
(12) Bushing 2 (57) Holder 1
(13) Screw 2 (58) Set screw 1
(14) Valve plate 1 (59) Spring 1
(15) Cylinder block 1 (60) O-Ring 1 JIS B 2401,1B,P16
(16) Collar 1 (61) O-Ring 1 JIS B 2401,1B,P8
(17) Spring 1 (62) Plug 1
(18) Collar 1 (63) O-Ring 1
4 JIS B 1176, M6x16
(19) Snap ring 1 JIS B 2804,48 HOLE (64) Socket head bolt 4
L
(20) Pin 3 (65) Stopper 1
(21) Piston ASSY 10 (66) Nameplate 1
(22) Retainer holder 1 (67) Drive screw 2
(23) Retainer plate 1 (68) Shipping plug 2 PF1/4
(24) Swash-plate 1 (69) Shipping plug 3 PF1/2
(25) Pin 1 (70) O-Ring 1
(26) Pin 1 (71) Pin 1
(27) O-Ring 4 JIS B 2401,1B,P8 (72) Pin 1
(28) Plug 29 (73) O-Ring 1
(29) Orifice 1 (74) Orifice 1
(30) Pin 1 (75) Shipping plate 1
(31) Spring 1 (76) Shipping plug 1
(32) Spring 1 (77) Orifice 1
(33) Spring seat 2 (78) O-Ring 1
(34) Valve ASSY 1 (35) to (41) (79) O-Ring 1
(35) Spool 1 (80) Stopper 1
(36) Valve sleeve 1 (81) Valve seat 1
(37) Pin 1 (82) Steel ball 2
(38) Collar 1 (83) Orifice 2
(39) O-Ring 1 (84) Seat 2
(40) Plug 1 (85) O-Ring 2
(41) O-Ring 1 (86) Shipping plug 1 PF3/8
(42) O-Ring 1 (87) Plug 1 PF3/8
(43) Nut 1 (88) O-Ring 6
(44) Gear Pump 1 (89) Collar 1
(45) Socket head bolt 2 (90) Orifice 1
RY9212001HYM0033US0
3-M24
3-M25
(1) Piston (4) Swash plate (7) Suction port A : Discharge side
(2) Retainer plate (5) Cylinder block (8) Discharge port B : Suction side
(3) Shoe (6) Valve plate (9) Discharge port
There are 10 pistons(1) built into the cylinder block(5) and coupled to the axle via a spline.
Also, one end of the cylinder block is in contact with a valve plate (6), which has two half-moon shaped ports
(kidney ports); these two kidney ports are connected to suction and discharge ports respectively, so when the cylinder
block rotates, the pistons are connected to the passage on the suction side for an interval of 180 degrees and to the
discharge side for the remaining interval.
The shoes(3) crimped so they can rotate freely against the ball on the end of the piston, and the retainer plate (2)
presses them against the swash-plate(4).
As a result, the shoes are always in contact with the swash-plate as it moves, so as the angle of the swash-plate
changes, that translates into changes in the stroke of the piston and ultimately alters the amount of discharge from
the pump.
As a result of the cylinder block rotation, the side that is pressed into the cylinder block by the piston via the
swash-plate is the discharge path.
At this time the compressed chambers of the cylinder block are connected to the kidney ports on the discharge
sideA and the side where the pistons are being withdrawn become the suction path and are connected to the suction
side kidney port.
As a consequence, during the interval of one revolution of the cylinder block, each piston alternately provides
suction at the suction port and then discharge at the discharge port. Thus, smooth pump operation is achieved by
having 10 pistons constantly alternating between suction and discharge.
The ports of the cylinder block are arranged alternately in different diameters; the discharge ports of the valve
plate also have two kinds of ports arranged inside/outside to match, so the flow to be discharged can be split off to
the inner/outer ports and consequently equivalent flow amounts can be obtained simultaneously.
RY9212001HYM0035US0
3-M26
(1) Discharge pressure P (3) Horsepower control spool (5) Horsepower control valve (7) Swash plate
(2) Control pin A (4) Control pin B (6) Horsepower control spring (8) Reaction pin
RY9212001HYM0036US0
2. When pressure P is low (when the load is low)
The discharge pressure (1) from the piston pump is
guided to control pin A (2) via oil passages inside the
case. The pressure guided to control pin A produces a
bias pressure equivalent to the pressure P against the
swash-plate, thus pressuring the swash-plate. When
pressure P is low, the horsepower control spool (3) is
positioned at the far left, thus connecting control pin B (4)
to the tank via the horsepower control spool, so there is
no force on control pin B, which results in the maximum
swash-plate tilt angle and discharge flow.
P1/P2: Piston pump discharge PPS:Valve inlet pressure
pressure PS: Suction pressure
P3: Gear pump discharge CH: Air bleeds
pressure
PP: Pilot pump discharge
pressure
PLS: Load pressure
RY9212001HYM0037US0
3-M27
(1) Discharge pressure P (3) Horsepower control spool (5) Horsepower control valve (9) Reaction pin
(2) Control pin A (4) Control pin B (6) Horsepower control spring
When the piston pump discharge pressure P (1) rises due to the load, the horsepower control spool (3) in the
middle of the diagram moves to the right. This connects discharge pressure P to control pin B (4), creating pressure
on control pin B and thus reducing the swash-plate tilt angle and reducing discharge flow. The pump discharge
pressure P is also connected to control pin A (2), but due to the difference in surface area, the swash-plate tilt angle
is reduced. When the swash-plate tilt angle is reduced, the horsepower control spool is moved back to the left by the
horsepower control springs (6), cutting off the connection between discharge pressure P and control pin B, and this
results in a balance of pressure.
RY9212001HYM0038US0
[D] LS Control
1. LS Control
LS control supplies the pressure and flow needed for
a given load by controlling the pump's discharge
pressure and flow so that pump discharge pressure PPS
= load pressure PLS + spring pressure.
(10) Spring (12) L/S regulator
(11) Spool
RY9212001HYM0004US0
3-M28
3-M29
3-M30
3-M31
5. CONTROL VALVE
[1] CONTROL VALVE [U48-4]
(1) Specifications
(1) T1 Port (9) Arm Rod (Pa4) (16) Swing Bottom (Pb8) (23) PP1 Port
(2) AUX1 (Pb1) (10) Boom bottom (Pb5) (17) Swing Rod (Pa8) (24) PAi Port
(3) AUX1 (Pa1) (11) Boom Rod (Pa5) (18) Blade Bottom (Pb9) (25) PPS2 Port
(4) Swivel Right (Pb2) (12) Travel Right Forward (Pb6) (19) Blade Rod (Pa9) (26) PLS Port
(5) Swivel Left (Pa2) (13) Travel Right Reverse (Pa6) (20) AUX2 (Pb10) (27) T2 Port
(6) Bucket Bottom (Pb3) (14) Travel Left Forward (Pb7) (21) AUX2 (Pa10) (28) T3 Port
(7) Bucket Rod (Pa3) (15) Travel Left Reverse (Pa7) (22) P Port (29) Main LS Valve (aLS)
(8) Arm Bottom (Pb4)
RY9212052HYM0002US0
3-M32
RY9212052HYM0003US0
3-M33
3-M34
(1) Main spool (7) Unload LS valve spring (13) Tank circuit (a) From variable pump
(2) Outlet section chamber (14) Main LS valve (b) To variable pump LS
(3) PPS pressure (8) Inlet section (15) Compensator spool regulator
(4) Unload LS spool (9) PLS pressure (16) PC passage (c) To variable pump
(5) Notch (10) LS drain plug (17) Pump pressure passage
(6) PLS passage (11) Micro orifice (18) Opening area
(12) PLS pressure passage
3-M35
3-M36
(2) Outlet section (7) Unload LS valve spring (11) Micro orifice (a) From variable pump
(3) PPS pressure chamber (12) PLS pressure passage (b) To variable pump LS
(4) Unload LS spool (8) Inlet section (13) Tank circuit regulator
(5) Notch (9) PLS pressure (14) Main LS valve (c) To variable pump
(6) PLS passage (10) LS drain plug
When the main spool moves, the hydraulic oil from the pump is channeled to the actuator. (For example, to A1)
On the other hand, the load pressure on the actuator passes through the PLS line (6) and operates the unload
LS valve spring chamber (7).
When the stroke of the main spool is large, the opening of the spool also becomes large and the pressure
differential between PPS and PLS becomes small.
When the differential pressure drops below the pressure setting of the unload LS valve, the unload LS spool (4)
moves to the left, closing off the notch (5).
Furthermore, the differential pressure drops and once it drops to the pump's LS control differential pressure
setting (refer to the pump's chapter), the pump's swash-plate tilt angle becomes large and it causes an increase in
the pump's discharge.
In order to prevent pressure from getting pent up in the PLS circuit in cases such as when the operator releases
the control lever, some of the hydraulic oil in the PLS circuit is released via the orifice (11) back to the tank.
RY9212001HYM0046US0
3-M37
(1) Pilot pressure (7) PLS pressure passage (12) Inlet section (a) From PPS2 port to variable
(2) Main spool (8) Micro orifice (13) PLS pressure passage pump
(3) Rod check poppet (9) LS drain plug (14) PC notch (b) From unload valve to tank
(4) Compensator spool (10) Tank circuit (15) C notch line
(5) LS pressure intake orifice (11) Air bleed micro-orifice (16) LSC notch (c) To variable pump
(6) Shuttle poppet (d) To pump pressure passage
When the pilot pressure (1) operates the Pa port, it moves the main spool (2) to the left and the hydraulic oil from
the pump passes through the PC notch (14) in the main spool and then the hydraulic oil flows through the C notch
(15) of the compensator spool (pressure compensator valve), the right side load check(3) and the LSC notch (16) and
then from port A to the actuator.
Part of the oil that passed through the PC notch goes through the LS pressure inlet orifice (5) of the compensator
spool (4), pushing up the shuttle poppet (6), passing through the PLS pressure passage (7) and guided to the variable
pump(c) as the PLS pressure.
RY9212001HYM0047US0
When operating multiple functions (when using AUX1 and swiveling, for example)
(1) High pressure selection (2) Compensator spool (A) AUX1 (B) Swivel
location
When AUX1 (A) and swivel (B) are operated at the same time, if the pressure load of swiveling is higher than that
of AUX1, the load pressure of swiveling is selected as the PLS pressure.
RY9212001HYM0005US0
3-M38
3-M39
The hydraulic oil on the boom rod side is locked by a control valve.
The hydraulic oil on the boom bottom side is locked by poppet A (2) of the anti-drift valve (1).
The poppet of the anti-drift valve is held down by the hold pressure on the boom bottom side.
RY9212052HYM0005US0
3-M40
(1) Main spool (4) Rod check poppet (7) Poppet B (10) Pin
(2) PC passage (5) Piston (8) Spring chamber (11) Poppet A
(3) Compensator spool (6) Spool (9) Anti-drift valve (12) Pilot pressure
When the boom is lowered, the hydraulic oil is guided from the pilot pump to the Pa port and presses the main
spool (1) to the left. The hydraulic oil from the pump passes through the PC passage (2), pushes up on the
compensator spool (3), passes through the load check valve (4) and flows from port A to the boom cylinder load side.
The oil from the pilot pump also flows to the Pi port and presses on the piston (5), spool (6) and poppet B (7).
The oil in the spring chamber (8) passes through a hole on the inside of the pin (10) in the anti-drift valve (9) and
then returns from the drain port to the tank. The spring chamber pressure drops, so the oil returning from the boom
cylinder bottom side passes through port B, pressing poppet A (11) open and returns to the hydraulic oil tank via the
tank line.
RY9212001HYM0049US0
3-M41
When the boom is lifted, the hydraulic oil is guided from the pilot pump to the Pb port and presses the main spool
(1) to the left. The hydraulic oil from the pump passes through the PC passage (2), pushes up on the compensator
spool (3) and passes through the load check valve (4), then it presses up on poppet A (5) and flows from port B to
the boom cylinder bottom side.
RY9212001HYM0050US0
3-M42
The mini-excavator is equipped with a travel communication circuit (1) in order to ensure its ability to travel in a
straight line. The oil of the left/right motor is connected when the mini-excavator is traveling straight (forward or
backwards).
RY9212001HYM0051US0
3-M43
(1) T1 Port (11) Boom Rod (Pa5) (21) P2 Port (31) PAi Port
(2) AUX1 (Pb1) (12) Travel Right Forward (Pb6) (22) P3 Port (32) PLS Port
(3) AUX1 (Pa1) (13) Travel Right Reverse (Pa6) (23) T2 Port (33) AUX2 (Pb10)
(4) Swivel Right (Pb2) (14) Travel Left Forward (Pb7) (24) T3 Port (34) AUX2 (Pa10)
(5) Swivel Left (Pa2) (15) Travel Left Reverse (Pa7) (25) PP1 Port
(6) Bucket Bottom (Pb3) (16) Swing Bottom (Pb8) (26) PP2 Port (a) Main Travel Right Relief
(7) Bucket Rod (Pa3) (17) Swing Rod (Pa8) (27) PP3 Port valve (aTR)
(8) Arm Bottom (Pb4) (18) Blade Rod (Pb9) (28) PPS1 Port (b) Main Travel Left Relief valve
(9) Arm Rod (Pa4) (19) Blade Bottom(Pa9) (29) PF1 Port (aTL)
(10) Boom bottom (Pb5) (20) P1 Port (30) PF2 Port (c) Main P3 Relief valve (aP3)
(d) Main LS Relief valve (aLS)
RY9212032HYM0008US0
3-M44
RY9212052HYM0006US0
3-M45
(1) AUX1 (9) Communication valve (A) Spool stroke (mm) (a) Boom, arm, bucket, AUX1,
(2) Swivel (10) Swing (B) Spool stroke (sub-spool) swivel
(3) Bucket (11) Blade (mm) (b) Travel, AUX2, swing, blade
(4) Arm (12) AUX2 (C) Spool stroke (main spool) (c) Spool closed
(5) Boom (mm)
(6) Independent travel valve A : Main spool pressure (D) Pilot pressure (MPa)
(7) Travel right receiver characteristics
(8) Travel left B : Independent travel valve
C : Communication valve
RY9212032HYM0009US0
3-M46
(1) Pilot pressure (8) Swing (15) Boom (a) To travel left section
(2) Pilot pressure (9) Blade (17) Communication valve section (b) To travel right section
(3) Independent travel valve (10) PAI port differential pressure (18) Communication valve (c) To tank
spool (11) AUX1 sub-spool
(4) Independent travel valve (12) Swivel (19) Communication valve spool
section (13) Bucket (20) Tank circuit
(5) Travel left section (14) Arm (21) AUX2
(6) Travel right section
(7) Main spool signal passage
section
3-M47
3-M48
(1) Arm dump (7) Communication valve section (13) Arm (a) Front (AUX1, swivel, bucket,
(2) Pilot pressure (8) Blade (14) Bucket arm and boom) section
(3) Communication valve (9) Swing (15) Swivel
sub-spool (10) Travel left (16) AUX1
(4) Communication valve spool (11) Travel right (17) Check valve
(5) Outlet section (12) Boom (18) AUX2
(6) Independent travel valve
section
(To be continued)
3-M49
3-M50
(1) Unload LS spool (6) Unload LS valve spring (11) Micro orifice (a) PLS passage
(5) Notch chamber
When the main spool moves, the hydraulic oil from the pump is channeled to the acutator. (For example, to A1)
On the other hand, the load pressure on the actuator passes through the PLS line (a) and operates the unload
LS valve spring chamber (6).
When the stroke of the main spool is large, the opening of the spool also becomes large and the pressure
differential between PPS and PLS becomes small. When the differential pressure drops below the pressure setting
of the unload LS valve, the unload LS spool (1) moves to the left, closing off the notch (5). Furthermore, the differential
pressure drops and once it drops to the pump's LS control differential pressure setting (refer to the pump's chapter),
the pump's swash-plate tilt angle becomes large and it causes an increase in the pump's discharge.
In order to prevent pressure from getting pent up in the PLS circuit in cases such as when the operator releases
the control lever, some of the hydraulic oil in the PLS circuit is released via the orifice (11) back to the tank.
RY9212001HYM0059US0
3-M51
(1) Pilot pressure (6) Shuttle poppet (11) LS drain plug (a) To variable pump
(2) Main spool (7) PLS pressure passage (12) Micro orifice (b) From unload LS valve to
(3) Load check poppet (8) Independent travel valve (13) Tank line tank line
(4) Control spool section (14) Air bleed micro-orifice (c) Pump passage
(5) LS pressure inlet orifice (9) Main travel relief valve
(10) PPS pressure
When the pilot pressure (1) operates the Pa port, it moves the main spool (2) to the left and the pressurized oil
from the pump passes through the Pc notch in the main spool and then the pressurized oil flows through the C notch
of the compensator spool (pressure compensator valve), the right side load check(3) and the LSC notch and then
from port A to the actuator.
Part of the oil that passed through the Pc notch goes through the LS pressure inlet orifice (5) of the compensator
spool (4), pushing up the shuttle poppet (6), passing through the PLS pressure passage (7) and to the variable pump
as the PLS pressure.
RY9212001HYM0060US0
When operating multiple functions (when using AUX1 and swiveling, for example)
(1) High pressure selection (2) Compensator spool (A) AUX1 (B) Swivel
location
When AUX1 (A) and swivel (B) are operated at the same time, if the pressure load of swiveling is higher than that
of AUX1, the load pressure of swiveling is selected as the PLS pressure.
RY9212001HYM0005US0
3-M52
3-M53
6. SWIVEL MOTOR
[1] SWIVEL MOTOR [U48-4, U55-4]
(1) Specifications
(1) Port A (3) Make-up port (5) Pilot port (parking brake) (6) Relief valve
(2) Port B (4) Drain port
RY9212032HYM0012US0
RY9212052HYM0007US0
3-M54
(2) Components
(A) Plug parts (1) (B) Plug parts (2) (C) Drain parts
3-M55
No. Name of part Q'ty Notes No. Name of part Q'ty Notes
(2),(20),
(1) Motor ASSY (with valves) 1 (46) Nut 2
(47) to (57)
(2) Motor ASSY 1 (3) to (19),(58) (47) Cover (motor) 1
(3) Ball bearing 1 (48) Plug (R1/4) 2
(4) Shaft 1 (49) Ball bearing 1
(5) Thrust plate 1 (50) Plate (valve) 1
(6) Cylinder block (swivel) 1 (51) Parallel pin 1
(7) Metal washer (spring) 1 (52) Parallel pin 2
(8) Spring CY 1 (53) Parallel pin 2
(9) Metal washer (spring) 1 (54) O-Ring 1
(10) Internal circlip 1 (55) O-Ring 2
(11) Pin 1 (56) Hex socket bolt 7
(12) Piston ASSY 9 (57) O-Ring 1
(13) Plate (retainer) 1 (58) O-Ring 2
(14) Holder (retainer) 1 (59) Gear case ASSY (swivel) 1 (60) to (82)
(15) Plate (friction) 1 (60) Gear case 1
(16) Piston (brake) 1 (61) Tapered roller bearing 1
(17) O-Ring 1 (62) Plate (valve) 1
(18) O-Ring 1 (63) Plate (pinion) 1
(19) Spring (NB) 12 (64) Plate (pinion 2) 1
(20) Valve ASSY (swivel) 1 (21) to (46) (65) Shaft (pinion) 1
(21) Housing (motor and valves) 1 (66) Oil Seal 1
(22) Poppet 2 (67) Tapered roller bearing 1
(23) Compression spring 2 (68) Spacer 2
(24) Plug 2 (69) Holder (2) 1
(25) O-Ring 2 (70) Collar (2) 4
(26) Piston (shockless) 1 (71) Needle bearing 4
(27) Plug (G1/2) 2 (72) Gear (planetary 2) 4
(28) O-Ring 2 (73) Plate (thrust 2) 4
(29) Valve ASSY (relief) 2 (30) to (46) (74) External circlip 4
(30) Housing (relief) 2 (75) Gear (sun) 1
(31) O-Ring 2 (76) External circlip 1
(32) O-Ring 2 (77) Holder (1) 1
(33) Ring (backup) 2 (78) Collar (1) 3
(34) Plug (relief) 2 (79) Needle bearing 3
(35) O-Ring 2 (80) Gear (planetary 1) 3
(36) Guide (spring) 2 (81) Plate (thrust) 1
(37) O-Ring 2 (82) Gear (drive) 1
(38) Ring (backup) 2 (83) Hex socket bolt 2
(39) Compression spring 2 (84) Filter 1
(40) Ring (spring seat) 2 (85) O-Ring 1
(41) Poppet 2 (86) Plug (G1/2) 1
(42) Ring (Poppet seat) 2 (87) O-Ring 1
(43) O-Ring 2 (88) Plug (G1/4) 1
(44) Backup ring 4 (89) O-Ring 1
(45) Set screw 2
RY9212001HYM0065US0
3-M56
3-M57
3-M58
3-M59
7. TRAVEL MOTOR
[1] TRAVEL MOTOR [U48-4]
(1) Specifications
(1) Counterbalance valve (3) Travel bi-speed / travel auto (6) Port PS (G1/4) (8) Oil supply port
(2) Anticavitation valve deceleration (7) Drain port (G1/4) (9) Oil check port
(4) Port P1 (G1/2) (10) Oil drain port
(5) Port P2 (G1/2)
Item U48-4
Maker Kubota Seiki
Model WM33
1498.8 / 856.0 cc/rev
Total displacement 1-speed/2-speed
(91.46 / 52.2 cu.in./rev)
31.616 / 18.056 cc/rev
Motor displacement 1-speed/2-speed
(1.93 / 1.1 cu.in./rev)
Reduction Ratio 1 : 47.406
24.5 MPa
Max Pressure (250 kgf/cm2)
(3550 psi)
51.0 L/min
Rated Flow (3100 cc.in./min)
(13.5 USGPM)
Theoretical RPM 1-speed/2-speed 34.0 / 59.6 rpm
5848 / 3340 N·m
Theoretical Torque Output 1-speed/2-speed (596.3 / 340.6 kgf·m)
(4313 / 2463 lbf·ft)
2509 N·m
Parking Brake Control Torque (255.8 kgf·m)
(1851 lbf·ft)
0.73 MPa
Parking Brake Release Pressure (7.4 kgf/cm2)
(110 psi)
20.7 MPa
2nd speed→1st speed (211 kgf/cm2)
Automatic Gear Shifting Pressure when (3000 psi)
PS=3.43 MPa (38 kgf/cm2, 497 psi) 21.1 MPa
1st speed→2nd speed (215 kgf/cm2)
(3060 psi)
RY9212052HYM0008US0
3-M60
(2) Components
(a) Counter-balance valve (c) Anti-cavitation valve (1) (d) Hi/Lo-speed shifting valve (e) Anti-cavitation valve (2)
(b) High pressure selector
valve
No. Name of part Qty Notes No. Name of part Qty Notes
(1) Motor ASSY (NB) 1 (6) Piston ASSY (B2) 1
(2) Oil seal 1 (7) Swash-plate (variable) 1
(3) Ball bearing 1 (8) Ball 2
(4) Shaft 1 (9) Cylinder block (travel) 1
(5) Compression spring (piston B) 1 (10) Metal washer (spring) 1
3-M61
No. Name of part Qty Notes No. Name of part Qty Notes
(11) Spring CY 1 (59) Poppet 1
(12) Metal washer (spring) 1 (2) to (24) (60) Spring (Anti-cavitation P) 1
(13) Internal snap ring 1 (61) Plug 1 GPF3/8
(14) Pin 3 (62) O-Ring 1
(15) Piston ASSY (A) 9 (63) Valve ASSY (anti-cavitation) 1 (64) to (72)
(16) Plate (retainer) 1 (64) Body (anti-cavitation) 1
(17) Holder (retainer) 1 (65) Spool (anti-cavitation) 1
(18) Plate (friction) 1 (66) Spring (anti-cavitation) 1
(19) Piston (brake) 1 (67) Orifice 2
(20) O-Ring 1 (68) Plug 2 GPF3/8
(21) O-Ring 1 (69) O-Ring 2
(22) Spring (NB1) 8 (70) O-Ring 5
(23) Spring (NB2) 4 (71) O-Ring 5
(24) O-Ring 1 (72) Plug 3 PT1/8
(25) Valve ASSY (counterbalance) 1 (26) to (62) (73) Gear case ASSY (wheel) 1 (74) to (101)
(26) Body (counterbalance) 1 (74) Holder (flange)
(27) Parallel pin 1 (75) Seal 1
(28) Orifice 1 (76) Bearing (angular) 1
(29) Plug 1 NPTF1/16 (77) Nut (ring) 1
(30) Orifice 2 (78) Set screw (M8 Sealock) 2
(31) Orifice 2 (79) Gear case 1
(32) O-Ring 1 (80) Ball 99
(33) Plunger (counterbalance) 1 (81) Plug 1 R1/8
(34) Poppet 2 (82) Plate (thrust B2) 4
(35) Compression spring 2 (83) Collar 4
(36) Plug 2 (84) Needle bearing 4
(37) O-Ring 2 (85) Gear (planetary B) 4
(38) Metal washer (spring) 2 (86) Plate (thrust B2) 1
(39) Compression spring 2 (87) External snap ring 4
(40) Plug 2 (88) Gear (sun) 1
(41) O-Ring 2 (89) Holder 1
(42) Spool (2-speed switch) 1 (90) Plate (thrust A) 1
(43) Spring (2-speed, S) 1 (91) Collar 3
(44) Spool (2-speed, S) 1 (92) Needle bearing 3
(45) Plug 1 GPF3/8 (93) Gear (planetary A) 3
(46) Pipe connector (2-speed) 1 (94) Gear (drive) 1
(47) O-Ring 2 (95) Plate (thrust C) 1
(48) Spool (high pressure selector) 1 (96) Cover 1
(49) Plug 2 GPF3/8 (97) O-Ring 1
(50) O-Ring 2 (98) Plug 3 GPF3/8
(51) Ball bearing 1 (99) O-Ring 3
(52) Plate (valve) 1 (100) Spring pin 4
(53) Parallel pin 2 (101) Plate (thrust d) 1
(54) Orifice 1 (102) Hex socket bolt 7
(55) Plug 1 NPTF1/16 (103) Hex socket bolt 4
(56) Plug 1 R1/8 (104) Plug 1 G1/4
(57) Parallel pin 2 (105) O-Ring 1
(58) O-Ring 1
RY9212001HYM0071US0
3-M62
3-M63
3-M64
(1) Plunger (2) Anti-cavitation valve (3) Spool (a) Control valve
(b) Motor
If pressurized oil flows to port P1, plunger (1) moves to the right and oil flows to the motor via passage M1, passes
through passage M2 and is expelled from port P2.
Pressurized oil also flows to the left end of spool (3) of the anti-cavitation valve (2) and presses the spool to the
right.
RY9212001HYM0075US0
3-M65
(1) Plunger (2) Anti-cavitation valve (3) Spool (a) Control valve
(4) Check valve (b) Motor
When decelerating, the motor continues to turn due to its inertia. As long as the counterbalance valve is open (the
plunger (1) is moved to the right), the motor's return oil is expelled from port P2.
At such time, there is not enough oil supplied under pressure from port P1, resulting in cavitation.
With this mechanism, the spool (3) of the anti-cavitation valve (2) moves to the right, and the pressure on the M2
passage side rises due to inertia, so the motor's return oil is resupplied to the motor via the anti-cavitation valve →
check valve (4) → around the plunger → M1 passage, so cavitation is reduced. (Anti-cavitation function)
RY9212001HYM0076US0
3-M66
(1) Plunger (2) Anti-cavitation valve (3) Spool (a) Control valve
(b) Motor
When the pressure on the supply side and the return side equalize, both the plunger (1) and the spool (3) of the
anti-cavitation valve (2) return to neutral.
RY9212001HYM0077US0
3-M67
(1) 2-speed switching spool (3) High-pressure selector valve (a) Control valve (c) Motor load pressure
(2) Motor load pressure (4) 2-speed switch piston (b) Motor (d) To 2-speed switch piston
This function gives priority to power for traveling and when the mini-excavator is traveling in the 2nd speed, if the
travel load becomes great, it automatically decelerates to 1st speed (low-speed).
When the travel load is low, it operates in the 2nd speed (high-speed).
When the green button on top of the dozer lever is pressed, it actuates the solenoid of the unload valve, thus
guiding oil from the pilot pump to the PS port.
When pressurized oil flows to the PS port, it presses the 2-speed switch spool (1) to the right as in the diagram.
(presses to the left in the circuit diagram) On the other hand, the load pressure (c) of the motor is applied in the motor
load pressure chamber (2) and presses the 2-speed switch spool to the left, as in the diagram (presses to the right in
the circuit diagram).
When the load is low, the force applied in the motor load pressure chamber is low and the area of the motor load
pressure chamber is smaller than the area on the PS port side, so the 2-speed switch spool is pressed to the right,
as in the diagram, which keeps the motor in 2nd speed (high speed).
Consequently, high pressure oil is supplied via the high pressure selection valve (3), and the 2-speed switch spool
to the 2-speed switch piston (4).
RY9212001HYM0078US0
3-M68
(1) 2-speed switching spool (a) Control valve (c) Motor load pressure (e) From case drain to drain
(3) High-pressure selector valve (b) Motor (d) From 2-speed switch piston port
(4) 2-speed switch piston
The motor load pressure (c) rises, so it overpowers the oil pressure from the PS port and moves the 2-speed
switch spool (1) to the left, as in the diagram (to the right in the circuit diagram) and switches to 1st speed (low speed).
When traveling in 1st speed, pressurized oil is not applied to the PS port, so it acts the same as when under a
heavy load.
RY9212001HYM0079US0
3-M69
[F] Decelerator
The drive gear (1) meshes with the 1st stage
planetary gear (2) while the 2nd stage sun gear (4)
meshes with the 2nd stage planetary gear (5). The 2nd
stage planetary carrier (6) is fixed to the body of the
decelerator.
Planetary gears (2) and (5) mesh with ring gear (7)
(the housing).
The drive force from the piston motor is transmitted
to the drive gear, which is decelerated by each of the
gears. The decelerated drive force is transmitted to the
ring gears via the 2nd stage planetary gear of the 2nd
stage planetary carrier, which is fixed to the final stage of
the decelerator. (The drive force from the 1st stage
planetary gear is also transmitted)
However, the input rotation is opposite the output
rotation.
3-M70
(1) Counterbalance valve/ (2) Travel 2-speed/travel (4) Port P2 (G1/2) (6) Drain port (G1/4)
anticavitation valve automatic reduction (5) Port PS (G1/4) (7) Oil inspection port
(3) Port P1 (G1/2) (2-speed travel switch) (8) Oil fill drain port
RY9212032HYM0013US0
3-M71
Item U55-4
Maker KYB
Model MAG-33VP-650F-4
1674 / 943 cc/rev
Total displacement 1-speed/2-speed
(102.2 / 57.5 cu.in./rev)
28.4 / 16.0 cc/rev
Motor displacement 1-speed/2-speed
(1.73 / 0.98 cu.in./rev
Reduction Ratio 1 : 58.943
26.5 MPa
Max Pressure (270 kgf/cm2)
(3840 psi)
56.1 L/min
Rated Flow (3420 cu.in./min)
(14.8 USGPM)
33.5 / 59.5 rpm
Theoretical RPM 1-speed/2-speed
at 56.1 L/min (3420 cu.in./min, 14.8 USGPM)
7060 / 3980 N·m
(719.9 / 405.8 kgf·m)
Theoretical Torque Output 1-speed/2-speed
( 5207 / 2935 lbf·ft)
at 26.5 MPa (270 kgf/cm2, 3840 psi)
4456 N·m
Parking Brake Control Torque (454.4 kgf·m)
( 3287 lbf·ft)
1.2 MPa
Parking Brake Release Pressure (12.2 kgf/cm2)
(174 psi)
3.92 MPa
Auto 2-speed Control Pilot Pressure (PS) (40.0 kgf/cm2)
(569 psi)
20.0 MPa
2nd speed→1st speed (202.7 kgf/cm2)
Motor Displacement Control Pressure (2883 psi)
when PS=3.92 MPa (40 kgf/cm2, 570 psi) 20.6 MPa
1st speed→2nd speed (208.8 kgf/cm2)
(2970 psi)
RY9212052HYM0009US0
3-M72
(2) Components
No. Name of part Q'ty Notes No. Name of part Q'ty Notes
(1) Decelerator ASSY 1 (1) to (28) (12) Inner race 4
(2) Flange holder 1 (13) Thrust washer 4
(3) Floating Seal 2 (14) Thrust plate 1
(4) Angular bearing 1 (15) Screw 4
(5) Ring nut 1 (16) Sun gear 1
JIS B 2804, 42
(6) Plug 2 (17) Thrust washer 3
SHAFT
(7) Housing 1 (18) Holder 1
(8) Steel ball 99 JIS B 1501, 1/4 (19) Planetary gear A 3
(9) Plug 2 PT1/8 (20) Cage and roller 3
(10) Planetary gear B 4 (21) Inner race 3
(11) Needle bearing 4 (22) Drive gear 1
3-M73
No. Name of part Q'ty Notes No. Name of part Q'ty Notes
(23) Thrust plate 1 (62) Spool ASSY 1 (63), (64)
(24) Cover 1 (63) Spool A 1
JIS B 2401, 1B,
(25) O-Ring 1 (64) Spool C 1
G190
(26) Wire 1 (65) Spring 1
(27) Plug 3 (66) Plug 1 PF3/8
(28) O-Ring 3 JIS B 2401, 1B, P14 (67) O-Ring 2 JIS B 2401, 1B, P14
(29) Shaft 1 (68) Plug 3 NPTF1/16
(30) Ball bearing 1 (69) Plug 1
(31) Oil Seal 1 (70) Orifice 6 M5x0.8x5L 0.5
JIS B 1176,
(32) Swash-plate 1 (71) Socket head bolt 6
M12x25L
(33) Steel ball 2 (72) Pin 4
(34) Cylinder block 1 (73) Valve ASSY 1 (74) to (81)
(35) Spring seat 1 (74) Valve body 1
(36) Spring 1 (75) Spool 1
(37) Washer 1 (76) Spring 2
JIS B 2804, 37
(38) Snap ring 1 (77) Spring seat 2
HOLE
(39) Pin 3 2.5x15.8L (78) Plug 2 PF3/8
(40) Retainer holder 1 (79) O-Ring 2 JIS B 2401, 1B, P14
(41) Retainer plate 1 (80) O-Ring 3 JIS B 2401, 1B, P12
(42) Piston ASSY 9 (81) Socket head bolt 3 JIS B 1176, M8x30L
(43) Piston 2 (82) Nameplate 1
(44) Spring 2 (83) Drive screw 2 1.85x4.8L
(45) Valve plate 1 (84) Shipping plug 2 PT1/2
(46) Pin 1 4x12L (85) Shipping plug 1 9/16UNF
(47) Ball bearing 1 (86) Plug 1 PT1/8
(48) O-Ring 1 AS568-25B, 1A (87) O-Ring 2 JIS B 2401, 1B, P8
(49) O-Ring 4 JIS B 2401, 1B, P7 (88) Plug 2
(50) Baseplate 1 (89) Plug 2
(51) Plunger ASSY 1 (52) to (56) (90) Brake piston 1
(52) Spool 1 (91) Disc 1
(53) Check valve 2 (92) Spring 8
(54) Spring 2 (93) Spring 4
(55) Plug 2 (94) O-Ring 1
(56) O-Ring 2 JIS B 2401, 1B, P10 (95) O-Ring 1
(57) Spring seat 2 (96) Orifice 2 M5x0.8x5L 0.5
(58) Spring 2 (97) Spring seat 1
(59) Cap 2 (98) Plug 2
(60) O-Ring 2 JIS B 2401, 1B, P29 (99) O-Ring 2 JIS B 2401, 1B, P14
(61) Orifice 2 M5x0.8x5L 0.5
RY9212001HYM0082US0
3-M74
3-M75
3-M76
3-M77
3-M78
(1) PS Port (3) Motor load pressure chamber (5) Pilot pressure area (a) Motor load pressure
(2) Spool (4) Motor load pressure area (6) 2-speed switch piston (b) Low pressure
(c) High pressure
When the mini-excavator is traveling in 2nd speed, if the travel load becomes great, this function gives priority to
power for traveling, automatically decelerating to 1st speed (low-speed). When the load is low, it operates in the 2nd
speed (high-speed).
When the green button on top of the dozer lever is pressed, it actuates the solenoid of the unload valve, thus
guiding oil from the pilot pump to the PS port (1). When pressure oil flows to the PS port, it moves the spool (2) to the
right.
On one hand, the motor load pressure (a) is applied in the motor load chamber (3) and moves the spool to the
left. When the load is low, the force applied in the motor load pressure chamber is slight and the motor load pressure
area (4) is also small, due to the pilot pressure area (5), so the spool is pushed to the right and the pressurized oil
from P1 is supplied to the 2-speed switch piston (6) on the P1 side.
RY9212001HYM0090US0
3-M79
(1) PS Port
(2) Spool
(3) 2-speed switch piston
The motor load pressure (a) rises, so it overpowers the oil pressure from the PS port (1) and moves the spool (2)
to the left, and switches to 1st speed (low speed).
When traveling in 1st speed, pressurized oil is not applied to the PS port, so it acts the same as when under a
heavy load.
RY9212001HYM0091US0
3-M80
[F] Decelerator
The drive gear (1) meshes with the 1st stage
planetary gear (2) while the 2nd stage sun gear (4)
meshes with the 2nd stage planetary gear (5). The 2nd
stage planetary carrier (6) is fixed to the body of the
decelerator.
Planetary gears (2) and (5) mesh with ring gear (7)
(the housing).
The drive force from the piston motor is transmitted
to the drive gear, which is decelerated by each of the
gears. The decelerated drive force is transmitted to the
ring gears via the 2nd stage planetary gear of the 2nd
stage planetary carrier, which is fixed to the final stage of
the decelerator. (The drive force from the 1st stage
planetary gear is also transmitted)
However, the input rotation is opposite the output
rotation.
3-M81
8. HYDRAULIC CYLINDER
[1] BOOM CYLINDER [U48-4, U55-4]
(1) Specifications
U48-4 U-55-4
Maker KYB
Tube outer diameter 108 mm (4.25 in.) 117 mm (4.61 in.)
Tube inner diameter 90 mm (3.5 in.) 95 mm (3.7 in.)
Rod diameter 50 mm (2.0 in.) 55 mm (2.2 in.)
Stroke 640 mm (25.2 in.) 690 mm (27.2 in.)
Max compressed length 990 mm (39.0 in) 1,074 mm (42.28 in)
RY9212052HYM0010US0
(2) Components
[A] [U48-4]
No. Name of part Qty Notes No. Name of part Qty Notes
(1) Cylinder tube ASSY 1 (12) Cushion seal 1
(2) Piston rod ASSY 1 (13) Collar 1
(3) Cylinder head 1 (14) Backup ring 1
(4) Bushing 1 (15) Cushion bearing 1
(5) U-ring 1 (16) Piston 1
(6) Wiper ring 1 (17) Sealing ASSY 1
(7) O-Ring 2 B2401 1B G 85 (18) Slide ring 2
(8) Backup ring 1 (19) Set screw 1
(9) O-Ring 1 B2401 1A G 90 (20) Steel ball 1
(10) Holder 1 (21) Pin bushing 2
(11) Cushion seal 1 (22) Grease nipple 1 B1575 B-PT1/8
RY9212001HYM0094US0
3-M82
[B] [U55-4]
No. Name of part Qty Notes No. Name of part Qty Notes
(1) Cylinder tube ASSY 1 (13) Cushion seal 2
(2) Piston rod ASSY 1 (14) Collar 1
(3) Cylinder head 1 (15) Backup ring 1
(4) Bushing 1 (16) Cushion bearing 1
(5) Snap ring 1 (17) Piston 1
(6) Buffer ring 1 (18) Sealing ASSY 1
(7) U-ring 1 (19) Slide ring 2
(8) Wiper ring 1 (20) Set screw 1 B1177 M10x10
(9) O-Ring 2 B2401 1B G 90 (21) Steel ball 1
(10) Backup ring 1 (22) Pin bushing 2
(11) O-Ring 1 B2401 1A G 95 (23) Grease nipple 1 B1575 B-PT1/8
(12) Holder 1
RY9212001HYM0095US0
3-M83
The discharge pressurized oil is automatically reduced on the lift end of the boom, slowing the operation of the
cylinder and cushioning the shock on the lift end of the boom. An indentation and a split in the cushion bearing are
provided as a means to reduce the pressure.
RY9212001HYM0096US0
3-M84
RY9212052HYM0011US0
(2) Components
[A] [U48-4]
No. Name of part Qty Notes No. Name of part Qty Notes
(1) Cylinder tube ASSY 1 (14) Backup ring 1
(2) Piston rod ASSY 1 (15) Cushion bearing 1
(3) Cylinder head 1 (16) Piston 1
(4) Bushing 1 (17) Sealing ASSY 1
(5) U-ring 1 (18) Slide ring 2
(6) Wiper ring 1 (19) Set screw 1
(7) O-Ring 2 B2401 1B G 75 (20) Steel ball 1
(8) Backup ring 1 (21) Cushion bearing 1
(9) O-Ring 1 B2401 1A G 80 (22) Cushion seal 1
(10) Holder 1 (23) Snap ring 1
(11) Cushion seal 1 (24) Stopper 2
(12) Spacer 1 (25) Pin bushing 2
(13) Collar 1
RY9212001HYM0098US0
3-M85
[B] [U55-4]
No. Name of part Qty Notes No. Name of part Qty Notes
(1) Cylinder tube ASSY 1 (15) Collar 1
(2) Piston rod ASSY 1 (16) Backup ring 1
(3) Cylinder head 1 (17) Cushion bearing 1
(4) Bushing 1 (18) Piston 1
(5) Snap ring 1 (19) Sealing ASSY 1
(6) Buffer ring 1 (20) Slide ring 2
(7) U-ring 1 (21) Set screw 1 B1177 M10x10
(8) Wiper ring 1 (22) Steel ball 1
(9) O-Ring 2 B2401 1B G 80 (23) Cushion bearing 1
(10) Backup ring 1 (24) Cushion seal 1
(11) O-Ring 1 B2401 1A G 85 (25) Snap ring 1
(12) Holder 1 (26) Stopper 2
(13) Cushion seal 1 (27) Pin bushing 2
(14) Spacer 1
RY9212001HYM0099US0
3-M86
The discharge pressurized oil is automatically reduced on the rake end of the arm, slowing the operation of the
cylinder and cushioning the shock on the rake end of the arm. An indentation and a split in the cushion bearing are
provided as a means to reduce the pressure.
RY9212001HYM0100US0
• Cushion function on dumping end of arm
3-M87
RY9212052HYM0012US0
(2) Components
[A] [U48-4]
No. Name of part Qty Notes No. Name of part Qty Notes
(1) Cylinder tube ASSY 1 (13) Set screw 1
(2) Piston rod ASSY 1 (14) Steel ball 1
(3) Cylinder head 1 (15) Pin bushing 1
(4) Bushing 1 (16) Pin bushing 1
(5) U-ring 1 (17) Pipe ASSY 1
(6) Wiper ring 1 (18) Pipe ASSY 1
(7) O-Ring 1 B2401 1B G 65 (19) Plug 2
(8) Backup ring 1 (20) O-Ring 4 B2401 1B P 22A
(9) O-Ring 1 B2401 1A G 70 (21) Bolt ASSY 2
(10) Piston 1 (22) Pipe holder 2
(11) Sealing ASSY 1 (23) Grease nipple 1 B1575 B-PT1/8
(12) Slide ring 2
RY9212001HYM0103US0
3-M88
[B] [U55-4]
No. Name of part Q'ty Notes No. Name of part Q'ty Notes
(1) Cylinder tube ASSY 1 (14) Slide ring 2
(2) Piston rod ASSY 1 (15) Set screw 1
(3) Cylinder head 1 (16) Steel ball 1
(4) Bushing 1 (17) Pin bushing 1
(5) Snap ring 1 (18) Pin bushing 1
(6) Buffer ring 1 (19) Pipe ASSY 1
(7) U-ring 1 (20) Pipe ASSY 1
(8) Wiper ring 1 (21) Plug 2
(9) O-Ring 1 B2401 1B G 70 (22) O-Ring 4 B2401 1B P 22A
(10) Backup ring 1 (23) Bolt ASSY 2
(11) O-Ring 1 B2401 1A G 75 (24) Pipe holder 2
(12) Piston 1 (25) Grease nipple 1 B1575 B-PT1/8
(13) Seal ring ASSY 1
RY9212001HYM0104US0
3-M89
RY9212052HYM0013US0
(2) Components
(a) G1/4
No. Name of part Q'ty Notes No. Name of part Q'ty Notes
(1) Cylinder tube (W) 1 (8) Gasket (dual) 1
(2) Rod (swing) 1 (9) O-Ring 1
(3) Bushing 2 (10) Piston 1
(4) Cylinder head 1 (11) Seal (piston) 1
(5) DU bushing 1 (12) Bushing 2
(6) Gasket 1 (13) Nut (SSN36) 1 M36x3
(7) Scraper 1
RY9212001HYM0106US0
3-M90
RY9212052HYM0014US0
(2) Components
No. Name of part Q'ty Notes No. Name of part Q'ty Notes
(1) Tube ASSY 1 (12) Backup ring 1
(2) Rod ASSY 1 (13) Seal 1
(3) Bearing 2 (14) O-Ring 1
(4) Piston 1 (15) Backup ring 1
(5) Nut 1 (16) O-Ring 1
(6) Seal ASSY 1 (17) Grease nipple 1
(7) Ring 2 (18) Grease nipple 1
(8) Head 1 (19) Pipe ASSY 1
(9) Bushing 1 (20) Clamp 1
(10) Circlip 1 (21) Bolt 1
(11) Seal 1
RY9212001HYM0108US0
3-M91
9. PILOT VALVE
[1] PILOT VALVE (BOOM, ARM, BUCKET, SWIVEL) [U48-4, U55-4]
(1) Specifications
1. Pilot Valve Left
(1) Port P (7) Independent operation torque A : Port 1, 3 (c) Operating torque (N·m)
(2) Port 1 (swivel left) (port 1) B : Port 2, 4 (d) Operating torque (kgf·cm)
(3) Port 2 (arm dump) (8) Independent operation torque (e) Pushrod stroke (mm)
(4) Port 3 (swivel right) (port 2) (a) Secondary pressure (f) Operating angle (deg)
(5) Port 4 (arm rake) (9) Independent operation torque (kgf/cm2)
(6) Port T (port 3) (b) Secondary pressure (MPa)
(10) Independent operation torque
(port 4)
(11) Secondary pressure
RY9212001HYM0109US0
3-M92
(1) Port P (7) Independent operation torque A : Port 1, 3 (c) Operating torque (N·m)
(2) Port 1 (bucket rake) (port 1) B : Port 2, 4 (d) Operating torque (kgf·cm)
(3) Port 2 (lower boom) (8) Independent operation torque (e) Pushrod stroke (mm)
(4) Port 3 (dump bucket) (port 2) (a) Secondary pressure (f) Operating angle (deg)
(5) Port 4 (lift boom) (9) Independent operation torque (kgf/cm2)
(6) Port T (port 3) (b) Secondary pressure (MPa)
(10) Independent operation torque
(port 4)
(11) Secondary pressure
RY9212001HYM0110US0
3-M93
(2) Components
Pilot valves left and right
3-M94
[B] Operation
1. When the control lever is in neutral
The force of the secondary pressure setting spring
(14) does not press on the spool (3). As a result, the
spool is held in a neutral position by return spring (11) or
(13). At such time, the output port (control valve port) (a)
and port T (b) are connected.
3-M95
(1) Port P (4) Port 2 (7) Operating torque (a) Secondary pressure (MPa)
(2) Port T (5) Port 3 (8) Secondary pressure (b) Operating angle (deg)
(3) Port 1 (6) Port 4 (c) Operating torque (N·m)
RY9212001HYM0114US0
3-M96
(2) Components
No. Name of part Q'ty Notes No. Name of part Q'ty Notes
(1) Shim 4 0.1T (17) Bushing 2
(2) Shim 4 0.2T (18) Plug 1
(3) Seat 3 (19) Collar 4
(4) Spring seat 4 (20) Flanged plug 6
(5) Pushrod 4 (21) Hex socket bolt 4 JISB1176 M4x12xP0.7
JISB1176
(6) Pin 2 (22) Hex socket bolt 2
M10x25xP1.5
(7) Plate, name 1 (23) Hex set screw 4 JISB1177 M6x6
(8) Shim 4 0.2T (24) Flat metal washer 4 JISB1256
(9) Shim 4 0.1T (25) Rivet screw 2 #2x4.8
(10) Spool 4 (26) Parallel pin 4 JISB1354
(11) Body 1 (27) Steel ball 7 JISB1501
(12) Cover 2 (28) O-Ring 4 JISB2401 1A P10
(13) Cam 2 (29) O-Ring 6 JISB2401 1B P11
(14) Spring 4 (30) O-Ring 4 1B AS568-022
(15) Spring 4 (31) O-Ring 1 1B AS568-904
(16) Collar 4 (32) Expander 2
RY9212001HYM0115US0
3-M97
[B] Operation
1. When the control lever is in neutral
The oil from the pilot pump that flows into Port P (a)
via the unload valve is cut off from port T (b) and port 1
(c) by the spool (10).
And port 1 is connected to port T through the inside
of the spool, so port 1 is at the tank pressure.
(10) Spool (a) Port P
(b) Port T
(c) Port 1
(d) Port 2
RY9212001HYM0116US0
3-M98
3-M99
(1) Port P (5) Operating torque (a) Secondary pressure (e) Pushrod stroke (mm)
(2) Port T (6) Secondary pressure (kgf/cm2) (f) Pedal operating angle (deg)
(3) Port 1 (b) Secondary pressure (MPa)
(4) Port 2 (c) Operating torque (N·m)
(d) Operating torque (kgf·cm)
RY9212001HYM0119US0
3-M100
(2) Components
No. Name of part Q'ty Notes No. Name of part Q'ty Notes
(1) Casing 1 (12) Spring seat 2
(2) Cover 1 (13) Washer 2
(3) Plug 2 (14) Spring 2
(4) Gasket 2 (15) Spring 2
(5) O-Ring 2 AS568-017 (16) Cam axle 1
(6) Pushrod 2 (17) Bushing 2
(7) Shim 2 (18) Cam 1
(8) RO plug 1 G1/4 (19) Steel ball 2
(9) O-Ring 1 JISB2401 P11 Hs90 (20) Hex set screw 1
(10) Hex socket bolt 2 JIS B 1176 SB-M6-16 (21) Bellows 1 HS50
(11) Spool 2
RY9212001HYM0120US0
3-M101
[B] Operation
1. When the control lever or pedal are in neutral
The force of the secondary pressure setting spring
(14) does not press on the spool (11). As a result, the
spool is held in a neutral position by the return spring
(15). At such time, the output port (control valve port and
port 1 (a) and port 2 (b)) and port T (d) are connected.
3-M102
(1) PAC port (accumulator) (3) Port B (2-speed travel switch) (5) Port P (to control valve) (7) Pilot primary relief valve (aPP)
(2) Port A (pilot operation, swivel (4) Drain port (to hydraulic oil (6) Port C (from pilot pump) (8) Check valve
parking brake) tank)
RY9212032HYM0021US0
3-M103
(2) Components
No. Name of part Q'ty Notes No. Name of part Q'ty Notes
(1) Plug 1 (12) Solenoid 2
(2) Plunger 1 (13) Screw adjustment 1
(3) Spring 1 (14) Flanged plug 2
(4) Spring 2 (15) Hex socket bolt 4
(5) Spool 2 (16) Hex socket bolt 2
(6) Plunger 1 (17) Hex nut 1
(7) Spring 1 (18) Rivet screw 2
(8) Plate, name 1 (19) O-Ring 2
(9) Cover 1 (20) O-Ring 1
(10) Plug 1 (21) O-Ring 1
(11) Body 1 (22) O-Ring 2
RY9212001HYM0123US0
3-M104
[B] Operation
With this device, oil from the pilot pump enters port C and is supplied to the control valve from port P, but that is
functionally identical to when oil from the pilot pump enters from port P and supplied to the control valve from port C.
Following is a description of when oil enters from port P from the pilot pump.
RY9212001HYM0125US0
1. When the solenoid is off
Oil from port P is cut off from passages to port A and
port T by a spool (5) and plunger (6). Ports A and T are
connected. And Port C and Port P are connected, so the
pressures at port C and port P are always the same.
3-M105
3-M106
RY9212032HYM0022US0
3-M107
(2) Components
No. Name of part Q'ty Notes No. Name of part Q'ty Notes
(1) Casing 1 (16) Spring 1
(2) O-Ring 1 AS568-118 (Hs90) (17) Spring 1
(3) O-Ring 2 JIS B 2401-P14 (Hs90) (18) Needle valve 1
(4) O-Ring 1 JIS B 2401-P18 (Hs90) (19) Hex nut 1
(5) O-Ring 1 AS568-015 (Hs90) (20) O-Ring 1 JIS B 2401-P6 (Hs90)
(6) O-Ring 1 AS568-014 (Hs90) (21) Plug 1
(7) Backup ring 1 (22) Spool 1
(8) Cap seal 1 (23) (1) Bushing 1
(9) Plug 1 M26 x 1.5 (24) Bushing (2) 1
(10) Plug 1 M6 x 1.5 (25) Bushing (3) 1
(11) Plug 6 (26) Relief valve 1
(12) Hex set screw 1 (27) Piston A 1
(13) Steel ball 1 (28) Piston B 1
(14) Spring seat 1 (29) Nameplate 1
(15) Poppet 1 (30) Parker coupler 2
RY9212032HYM0023US0
3-M108
[B] Operation
1. During Cylinder Hold
The holding pressure of boom cylinder (b) passes
through port B, around spool (22) and is guided to the
spring chamber of the poppet (15). Therefore, since the
poppet is pressed onto the casing (1), it is seated. Due
to this, the passage for oil returning to the boom cylinder
bottom is shut off, so cylinder drift is prevented.
(1) Casing A : Port A
(15) Poppet B : Port B
(22) Spool PL : Pilot pressure port
DR : Drain port
(a) Control Valve
(b) Boom Cylinder
RY9212032HYM0025US0
2. Boom-up operation
When a boom-up operation is conducted, pressure
oil from control valve (a) passes through port A, pushes
up the poppet (15), and flows from port B to the boom
cylinder (b) bottom.
(1) Casing A : Port A
(15) Poppet B : Port B
(22) Spool PL : Pilot pressure port
DR : Drain port
(a) Control Valve
(b) Boom Cylinder
RY9212032HYM0026US0
3-M109
4. During Overload
While the boom cylinder (b) is held, the relief valve
(26) operates when the cylinder is overloaded. The hold
pressure on the cylinder bottom side passes through the
relief valve and is guided to the chamber K (c).
Piston A (27) pushes against the spring (16) to press
down the spool (22), so that oil from port B passes
around the spool, though port A and the control valve (a),
avoiding the tank.
(1) Casing (a) Control Valve
(15) Poppet (b) Boom Cylinder
(16) Spring (c) Chamber K
(22) Spool
(26) Relief valve A : Port A
(27) Piston A B : Port B
PL : Pilot pressure port
DR : Drain port
RY9212032HYM0028US0
3-M110
Item Specifications
3.9 MPa
Max operating pressure
40 kgf/cm2
(input pressure)
570 psi
1.0 MPa
Allowable back pressure
10 kgf/cm2
(pressure T)
100 psi
Maximum proportional valve
operating flow volume 15.6 L/min, 4.1 GPM
(input flow volume)
AUX1 : 0.4 L/min ≥
AUX1, 2 : 0.8 L/min ≥
Drain volume when solenoid off
(At 20 cST, port P pressure =
4.9 MPa, 50 kgf/cm2, 710 psi)
Waterproof Standard JIS D 0203 S2 equivalent
Vibration Proof Standard JIS D 1601–1995
Hydraulic Oil Grade ISO VG32 to 68 equivalent
Hydraulic Oil Contamination
NAS Class 10 ≥
Level
Rated Amperage: 1600 mA
Electrical Specifications Coil resistance: 3.2 ± 0.5 Ω
(at 20 °C, 68 °F)
0 to 2.7 MPa
Second pressure control range 0 to 27 kgf/cm2
0 to 390 psi
3-M111
3-M112
(2) Components
AUX1
(1) Filter (2) Adapter (3) AUX1 (SP1 High) (4) AUX1 (SP1 Low)
RY9212032HYM0038US0
AUX1, 2
(1) Filter (3) AUX1 (SP1 High) (5) AUX2 (SP2 High) (7) Base
(2) Adapter (4) AUX1 (SP1 Low) (6) AUX2 (SP2 Low)
RY9212032HYM0039US0
3-M113
3-M114
Merits:
Very little power is lost and fine movements of work
equipment can be controlled.
Demerits:
The circuitry is complex. And this complexity can
easily lead to high rates of failure and increased costs.
3-M115
(1) Right (Max) (3) Right (Idle) (A) AUX2 (a) Flow volume L/min
(2) Left (Max) (4) Left (Idle) (B) AUX1 (b) Operating lever knob
(limit value)
The relationship between pressure P, flow Q and lever knob operation (limit value) changes proportionally as
shown in the figures above.
CAUTION
• There is deviation between machines on account of the n = 1 measurement being entered.
RY9212052HYM0023US0
Relationship between Lever Operation and Hydraulic Flow (Proportional Control) [U55-4]
(1) Right (Max) (3) Right (Idle) (A) AUX2 (a) Flow volume L/min
(2) Left (Max) (4) Left (Idle) (B) AUX1 (b) Operating lever knob
(limit value)
The relationship between pressure P, flow Q and lever knob operation (limit value) changes proportionally as
shown in the figures above.
CAUTION
• There is deviation between machines on account of the n = 1 measurement being entered.
RY9212052HYM0015US0
3-M116
[B] Structure
Solenoid Valve Cross-section (AUX1 Spec)
(1) Hex bolt (M5x0.8) (2) Proportional control solenoid (a) Port P (c) Port T
(b) Port A
7 ± 1 N·m
Tightening torque Hex bolt (1) 0.7 ± 0.1 kgf·m
5.2 ± 0.7 lbs·ft
NOTE
• The adjustment nut on top of the solenoid is set in advance when shipped from the factory.
• Service port flow. Do not adjust the feel with this nut. (Adjust according to the digital panel procedures.)
RY9212032AVM0012US0
3-M117
(1) Knob's slide switch (5) Knob characteristics (a) Red (g) Green
(2) Remote operation control (6) Characteristic circuit diagram (b) Black (h) Blanking pin
knob (w/ one-way hold) (7) Diagram of Hydraulic Circuit (c) White (i) Proportional control
(3) Harness coupler (d) Blue (j) 45 °
(4) Side view of entire knob (e) Gray (k) 19 °
(f) Yellow (L) 21.5 °
This knob switch comes equipped with an IC chip that processes the signal of the potentiometer.
1. Service mode: set up in the service mode of the meter panel.
2. Knob control: Output can be controlled with the left/right knob switch to suit operating conditions.
3. Breaker operation: the button on the front of the operation lever can be used to switch to one-way hold.
RY9212032HYM0044US0
3-M118
(1) Knob's slide switch (5) Knob characteristics (a) Red (g) Green
(2) Remote operation control (6) Characteristic circuit diagram (b) Black (h) Blanking pin
knob (w/ one-way hold) (7) Diagram of Hydraulic Circuit (c) White (i) Proportional control
(3) Harness coupler (d) Blue (j) 45 °
(4) Side view of entire knob (e) Gray (k) 19 °
(f) Yellow (L) 21.5 °
This knob switch comes equipped with an IC chip that processes the signal of the potentiometer.
1. Service mode : set up in the service mode of the meter panel.
2. Knob control : Output can be controlled with the left / right knob switch to suit operating conditions.
RY9212032HYM0045US0
3-M119
(1) Main pump (3) Main control valve, service (4) Thumb cylinder (a) PWM signal
(2) Main pump Pp port section (b) Bottom (Thumb crowd)
(c) Rod (Thumb dump)
RY9212032AVM0029US0
3-M120
CONTENTS
1. PUMP ..........................................................................................................................................3-S1
[1] PUMP DISASSEMBLY / ASSEMBLY ...................................................................................3-S1
[2] PUMP DISASSEMBLY PROCEDURES [U48-4]...................................................................3-S7
(1) Disassembly Procedures.................................................................................................3-S9
(2) Assembly Procedures....................................................................................................3-S13
[3] PUMP DISASSEMBLY PROCEDURES [U55-4].................................................................3-S18
(1) Disassembly Procedures...............................................................................................3-S20
(2) Assembly Procedures....................................................................................................3-S26
[4] SPECIAL TOOLS ................................................................................................................3-S32
[5] STANDARDS FOR REPLACING PUMP PARTS................................................................3-S33
2. CONTROL VALVE.....................................................................................................................3-S34
[1] CONTROL VALVE REMOVAL ............................................................................................3-S34
[2] CONTROL VALVE DISASSEMBLY / ASSEMBLY PROCEDURES ...................................3-S39
(1) Control Valve [U48-4] ....................................................................................................3-S40
(2) Control Valve [U55-4] ....................................................................................................3-S51
3. SWIVEL MOTOR.......................................................................................................................3-S63
[1] REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION OF THE SWIVEL MOTOR.............................................3-S63
[2] SWIVEL MOTOR ASSEMBLY PROCEDURES ..................................................................3-S66
(1) Assembly Procedures....................................................................................................3-S68
4. SWIVEL JOINT..........................................................................................................................3-S77
[1] SWIVEL JOINT REMOVAL & INSTALLATION ...................................................................3-S77
5. TRAVEL MOTOR ......................................................................................................................3-S81
[1] REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION OF THE TRAVEL MOTOR ............................................3-S81
[2] TRAVEL MOTOR DISASSEMBLY / ASSEMBLY PROCEDURES [U48-4] ........................3-S84
(1) Disassembly Procedures...............................................................................................3-S86
(2) Assembly Procedures....................................................................................................3-S96
[3] TRAVEL MOTOR DISASSEMBLY / ASSEMBLY PROCEDURES [U55-4] ......................3-S111
(1) Disassembly Procedures.............................................................................................3-S113
(2) Assembly Procedures..................................................................................................3-S123
[4] SPECIAL TOOLS ..............................................................................................................3-S137
6. HYDRAULIC CYLINDER.........................................................................................................3-S140
[1] HYDRAULIC CYLINDER DISASSEMBLY / ASSEMBLY PROCEDURES........................3-S140
(1) Cylinder Components ..................................................................................................3-S140
(2) Disassembly Procedures.............................................................................................3-S142
(3) Assembly Procedures..................................................................................................3-S146
7. PILOT VALVE (CONTROL).....................................................................................................3-S153
[1] PILOT VALVE (CONTROL) ASSEMBLY ..........................................................................3-S153
[2] PILOT VALVE (CONTROL) DISASSEMBLY / ASSEMBLY PROCEDURES....................3-S155
(1) Pilot valve components................................................................................................3-S155
(2) Disassembly ................................................................................................................3-S155
(3) Assembly .....................................................................................................................3-S159
(4) U-joint Tightening Tool ................................................................................................3-S162
8. PILOT VALVE (TRAVEL) ........................................................................................................3-S163
[1] PILOT VALVE (TRAVEL) ASSEMBLY ..............................................................................3-S164
[2] PILOT VALVE (TRAVEL) DISASSEMBLY / ASSEMBLY PROCEDURES .......................3-S165
(1) Disassembly Procedures.............................................................................................3-S165
(2) Assembly Procedures..................................................................................................3-S168
9. PILOT VALVE (BLADE, SWING) ............................................................................................3-S173
[1] PILOT VALVE (BLADE, SWING) ASSEMBLY ..................................................................3-S173
1. PUMP
[1] PUMP DISASSEMBLY / ASSEMBLY
CAUTION
• When removing a hydraulic device after operating the mini-excavator, lower the bucket and blade to the
ground and turn off the engine.
• Each of the devices and the hydraulic oil are hot and under high pressure immediately after operating the
mini-excavator. If the hydraulic oil reached a high operating temperature, it may cause a burn.
• Oil gushing out under pressure has enough force to pierce your skin and may cause you injury. Always
allow the temperature to drop and relieve any remaining pressure prior to working to remove any
hydraulic equipment.
RY9212001MBS0004US0
Removing the bonnet (left)
1. Remove the five spots of attaching bolts (2), (3) of the bonnet
(left) (4) and the cap (1) of the fuel tank, and remove the bonnet
(left) (4).
Leave the bonnet (rear) open, removing/attaching will be easier.
(1) Cap, assy (3) Bolt (M10 x 25)
(2) Bolt (M10 x 35) (4) Bonnet (left)
RY9212052HYS0001US0
2. Remove the mounting bracket (4) and four mounting bolts (5) of
the bonnet (rear) and remove the bracket (4).
(1) Bolt (M8 x 16) (4) Bracket
(2) Pin (5) Bolt (M10 x 20)
(3) Bonnet (rear)
RY9212052HYS0115US0
3-S1
3-S2
2. Loosen the suction hose tightening clamp (3), and remove the
suction hose (4) from the pump.
3. Suspend the pump (1) by a nylon sling (5), and support with a
crane. Remove the bolts (2) in two locations, and pull the shaft
of the pump suspended by the crane from the coupling.
196.1 to 225.6 N·m
Tightening torque Pump assembly (piston) 20 to 23 kgf·m
144.7 to 166.3 lbf·ft
• Pump weight: Approx. 35 kg (77 lbs)
Approx. 38 kg (84 lbs)
(1) Pump assembly (piston) (4) Hose (suction 1)
(2) Bolt (M16 x 35) (5) Nylon sling
(3) Hose clamp (6) Coupling
RY9212052HYS0113US0
3-S3
(a) 30 °
(b) 45 °
RY9212052HYS0004US0
3-S4
(a) 60 °
(b) 45 °
(c) 30 °
RY9212052HYS0006US0
3-S5
IMPORTANT
• Do not apply a threadlock.
RY9212001HYS0029US0
3-S6
3-S7
No. Name of part Qty Notes No. Name of part Qty Notes
(1) Case 1 (43) O-Ring 1 JIS B 2401,1B,P14
(2) Bearing 1 (44) O-Ring 2 JIS B 2401,1B,P11
(3) Flange 1 (45) Nut 1
(4) Needle bearing 1 (46) Gear pump 1
(5) Oil Seal 1 (47) Socket head bolt 4 JIS B 1176,M8x65 L
(6) Snap ring 1 JIS B 2804,42 HOLE (48) Washer 4
JIS B 1176,
(7) Shaft 1 (49) Socket head bolt 6
M12x35 L
(8) Thrust washer 1 (50) Plug 2
(9) Thrust washer 1 (51) Valve ASSY 1 (52)~(65)
(10) Gasket 1 (52) Valve body 1
(11) Pin 3 6x12 L (53) Spool 1
(12) Bushing 2 (54) Bushing 1
(13) Screw 2 (55) Spring seat 1
(14) Valve plate 1 (56) Cap 1
(15) Cylinder block 1 (57) Nut 1
(16) Collar 1 (58) Nut 1
(17) Spring 1 (59) Holder 1
(18) Collar 1 (60) Set screw 1
(19) Snap ring 1 JIS B 2804,48 HOLE (61) Spring 1
(20) Pin 3 (62) O-Ring 1 JIS B 2401,1B,P16
(21) Piston ASSY 9 (63) O-Ring 1 JIS B 2401,1B,P8
(22) Retainer holder 1 (64) Plug 1
(23) Retainer plate 1 (65) O-Ring 1 JIS B 2401,1B,P11
(24) Swash-plate 1 (66) Socket head bolt 4 JIS B 1176,M6x16 L
(25) Pin 1 (67) Stopper 1
(26) Pin 1 (68) Nameplate 1
(27) O-Ring 6 JIS B 2401,1B,P8 (69) Drive screw 2
(28) Plug 17 (70) Shipping plug 2 PF1/4
(29) Orifice 1 (71) Shipping plug 1 PF3/4
(30) Pin 1 (72) O-Ring 1
(31) Spring 1 (73) Pin 1
(32) Spring 1 (74) O-Ring 1 JIS B 2401,1B,P3
(33) Spring seat 2 (75) Pin 1
(34) Valve ASSY 1 (35)~(43) (76) Shipping plug 1 PF3/8
(35) Spool 1 (77) O-Ring 1
(36) Valve sleeve 1 (78) Orifice 1
(37) Servo piston 1 (79) O-Ring 1
(38) O-Ring 1 JIS B 2401,1B,P8 (80) Shipping plate 1
(39) O-Ring 1 (81) Shipping plug 1 PT1/4
(40) Pin 1 (82) Plug 1
(41) Collar 1 (83) O-Ring 1
(42) Plug 1 PF3/8
RY9212001HYS0030US0
3-S8
IMPORTANT
• Take care not to scratch the suction or discharge ports in
the vise.
CAUTION
• If the flange is difficult to remove, tap lightly on it with a
plastic hammer and take it apart.
• Don't pinch your fingers between the flange and the case.
(3) Flange
RY9212001HYS0033US0
4. Remove the screw (13) and the bushing (12).
CAUTION
• Take care so the snap ring does not go flying.
3-S9
CAUTION
• Be careful not to cut your fingers on the gasket.
(10) Gasket
RY9212001HYS0037US0
(24) Swash-plate
RY9212001HYS0039US0
(7) Shaft
RY9212001HYS0040US0
3-S10
IMPORTANT
• Do not scratch the valve plate.
(26) Pin
RY9212001HYS0045US0
3-S11
IMPORTANT
• Measure the width of L before removing the nut.
(45) Nut
RY9212001HYS0046US0
3-S12
(78) Orifice
RY9212001HYS0050US0
2.5 N·m
Tightening torque Orifice (78) 0.25 kgf·m
1.8 lbf·ft
• Tool to use: M3 hex socket
(78) Orifice
RY9212001HYS0051US0
12.7 N·m
Tightening torque Socket head bolt (66) 1.3 kgf·m
9.37 lbf·ft
• Tool to use: M5 hex socket
(39) O-Ring
RY9212001HYS0054US0
3-S13
IMPORTANT
• Install the nut and adjust it to the width measured before
disassembly.
68.6 N·m
Tightening torque Nut (45) 7.0 kgf·m
50.6 lbf·ft
• Tool to use: M41 socket
RY9212001HYS0055US0
6. Clamp the case in a vice and install pins (30), (73) and(26).
IMPORTANT
• Take care not to scratch the suction or discharge ports in
the vise.
IMPORTANT
• Apply hydraulic oil to both faces of the valve plate.
3-S14
IMPORTANT
• Apply grease to the pins.
10. Install the retainer holder (22) onto the cylinder block.
11. Install the piston ASSY (21) into the retainer plate (23) and then
install it into the cylinder block.
IMPORTANT
• Do not scratch the pistons.
• Do not use a hammer.
• Apply hydraulic oil to the body and shoe face of the
pistons.
IMPORTANT
• Apply hydraulic oil to the sliding surfaces of the cylinder
block.
• Assemble carefully to avoid scratching.
RY9212001HYS0062US0
(7) Shaft
RY9212001HYS0063US0
3-S15
IMPORTANT
• Install so the sliding surfaces of the piston shoes are not
scratched.
• Double-check that the swash-plate is facing the right
direction.
CAUTION
• Be careful not to cut your fingers on the gasket.
(10) Gasket
RY9212001HYS0066US0
IMPORTANT
• Install the snap ring so its angled surface faces the outside
of the housing.
3-S16
IMPORTANT
• Apply grease to the lip of the oil seal.
19. Use the jig (a) to install the needle bearing (4) into the flange (3).
IMPORTANT
• Press the bearing in so its stamped side is facing up.
IMPORTANT
• Be careful that the bushing faces the right direction.
5.9 N·m
Tightening torque Screw (13) 0.6 kgf·m
4.4 lbf·ft
• Tool to use: M3 hex socket
44.1 N·m
Tightening torque Socket head bolt (47) 4.5 kgf·m
32.5 lbf·ft
• Tool to use: M6 hex socket
3-S17
3-S18
RY9212001HYS0073US0
3-S19
3. Turn so the input axle is facing up, clamp the pump into a vice
and remove the bolts.
IMPORTANT
• Take care not to scratch the suction or discharge ports in
the vise.
CAUTION
• If the flange is difficult to remove, tap lightly on it with a
plastic hammer and take it apart.
• Don't pinch your fingers between the flange and the case.
(3) Flange
RY9212001HYS0077US0
3-S20
CAUTION
• Take care so the circlip does not go flying.
7. Remove the oil seal (5) and the needle bearing (4) from the
flange.
CAUTION
• Be careful not to cut your fingers on the gasket.
(10) Gasket
RY9212001HYS0081US0
(7) Shaft
RY9212001HYS0083US0
3-S21
(24) Swash-plate
RY9212001HYS0084US0
IMPORTANT
• Do not scratch the valve plate.
3-S22
IMPORTANT
• Measure the width of L before removing the nut.
(43) Nut
RY9212001HYS0090US0
3-S23
(48) Plug
RY9212001HYS0095US0
(80) Stopper
RY9212001HYS0096US0
3-S24
(48) Plug
RY9212001HYS0097US0
25. Pull out the valve seat (81) and the steel ball (82) with a magnet.
(48) Plug
RY9212001HYS0099US0
27. Pull out the collar (89) and the steel ball (82) with a magnet.
3-S25
IMPORTANT
• Be careful that the valve seat faces the right direction.
29.4 N·m
Tightening torque Plug (48) 3.0 kgf·m
21.7 lbf·ft
• Tool to use : M6 hex socket
(48) Plug
RY9212001HYS0102US0
10.3 N·m
Tightening torque Orifice (29) 1.1 kgf·m
7.6 lbf·ft
• Tool to use : M4 hex socket
(29) Orifice
RY9212001HYS0103US0
4. Install the O-rings (27) and (73) on the face where the case's
valve ASSY will be installed.
3-S26
2.5 N·m
Tightening torque Orifice (74) 0.25 kgf·m
1.8 lbf·ft
• Tool to use : M3 hex socket
(74) Orifice
RY9212001HYS0105US0
12.7 N·m
Tightening torque Socket head bolt (64) 1.3 kgf·m
9.4 lbf·ft
• Tool to use : M5 hex socket
(41) O-Ring
RY9212001HYS0107US0
IMPORTANT
• Install the nut and adjust it to the width measured before
disassembly.
68.6 N·m
Tightening torque Nut (43) 7.0 kgf·m
50.6 lbf·ft
• Tool to use : M41 socket
(43) Nut
RY9212001HYS0108US0
3-S27
IMPORTANT
• Take care not to scratch the suction or discharge ports in
the vise.
IMPORTANT
• Position so the notch is aligned with the pin.
• Apply hydraulic oil to both faces of the valve plate.
13. Insert the three pins (20) into the cylinder block (15).
IMPORTANT
• Apply grease to the pins.
3-S28
15. Install the piston ASSY (21) into the retainer plate (23) and then
install it into the cylinder block.
IMPORTANT
• Do not scratch the pistons.
• Do not use a hammer.
• Apply hydraulic oil to the body and shoe face of the
pistons.
IMPORTANT
• Apply hydraulic oil to the sliding surfaces of the cylinder
block.
• Assemble carefully to avoid scratching.
IMPORTANT
• Install so the sliding surfaces of the piston shoes are not
scratched.
• Double-check the swash-plate is facing the right direction.
3-S29
CAUTION
• Be careful not to cut your fingers on the gasket.
(10) Gasket
RY9212001HYS0119US0
IMPORTANT
• Install the internal circlip so its angled surface faces the
outside of the housing.
21. Use the jig (a) to insert the oil seal (3) into the flange (5).
IMPORTANT
• Apply grease to the lip of the oil seal.
22. Use the jig (a) to install the needle bearing (4) into the flange (3).
IMPORTANT
• Press the bearing in so its stamped side is facing up.
3-S30
IMPORTANT
• Be careful that the bushing faces the right direction.
5.9 N·m
Tightening torque Screws (13) 0.6 kgf·m
4.4 lbf·ft
• Tool to use : M3 hex socket
44.1 N·m
Tightening torque Socket head bolt (45) 4.5 kgf·m
32.5 lbf·ftlbf·ft
• Tool to use : M8 hex socket
3-S31
3-S32
Piston ASSY
Retainer plate 1. If the sliding surface has deep scratches, seizing, uneven wear or is very
Retainer holder rough.
Swash-plate ASSY 1. If the sliding surface has deep scratches or is very rough.
Bushing 1. If the sliding surface has deep scratches or is very rough.
RY9212001HYS0130US0
3-S33
2. CONTROL VALVE
[1] CONTROL VALVE REMOVAL
CAUTION
• When removing a hydraulic device after operating the mini-excavator, lower the bucket and blade to the
ground and turn off the engine.
• Each of the devices and the hydraulic oil are hot and under high pressure immediately after operating the
mini-excavator. If the hydraulic oil reached a high operating temperature, it may cause a burn.
• Oil gushing out under pressure has enough force to pierce your skin and may cause you injury. Always
allow the temperature to drop and relieve any remaining pressure prior to working to remove any
hydraulic equipment.
RY9212001MBS0004US0
Removing the bonnet (right)
1. Open the bonnet (right) (4), remove the snap rings (1) and (2) in
two locations, and separate the gas damper (3) and bonnet.
2. Slide the bonnet (right) (4) towards the front of the machine to
remove.
CAUTION
• Be sure to use 2 or more persons for removing the bonnet
(right).
3-S34
WARNING
• When disconnecting the battery cords, be sure to
disconnect the negative cord first. When re-connecting,
connect the positive cord first.
CAUTION
• Plug all disconnected hydraulic hoses, and affix
identification labels on each for reassembly.
RY9212001HYS0133US0
Removing the control valve
1. Fit an eyebolt (M10 pitch 1.25) (6) into the bracket (control
valve) (1) bolt hole, and suspend the control valve assembly (2)
by the crane.
2. Remove the mounting bolts (3) and (4) (six locations) of the
bracket (control valve) (1), and remove using the crane.
IMPORTANT
• Apply a threadlock (Loctite #271).
3-S35
(1) Bracket (control valve) (3) Bolt (M12x25) (a) Mounting hole always used (d) Mounting hole to use for
(2) Control Valve (4) Bolt (M12x25) (b) Mounting hole to use for U48-4 spec.
U55-4 spec. (e) Mounting hole to use for
(c) Hole not used AUX2 spec.
RY9212052HYS0024US0
Removing the control valve assembly
1. Remove the control valve assembly (1) mounting bolts (3), and
remove the control valve assembly from the bracket (control
valve) (2).
IMPORTANT
• Apply a threadlock (Loctite #271).
3-S36
(1) Control valve assembly (9) Arm, bottom (16) Travel left rear (a) 10 °
(2) T1, PLS (10) Arm, rod (17) Swing, bottom (b) 30 °
(3) AUX1. Low (11) Boom, bottom (18) Swing, rod (c) 45 °
(4) AUX1. High (12) Boom, rod (19) Blade, bottom (d) 60 °
(5) Swivel right (13) Travel right forward (20) Blade, rod
(6) Swivel left (14) Travel right rear (21) T2, Pp1, Pai
(7) Bucket, bottom (15) Travel left forward (22) T2
(8) Bucket, rod
RY9212052HYS0009US0
3-S37
(1) Control valve assembly (9) Arm, bottom (17) Travel left rear (a) 20 °
(2) T1, PLS (10) Arm, rod (18) P3, T2 (b) 30 °
(3) AUX1. Low (11) Boom, bottom (19) Swing, bottom (c) 45 °
(4) AUX1. High (12) Boom, rod (20) Swing, rod (d) 60 °
(5) Swivel right (13) P1, P2, PPS (21) Blade, rod (e) 10 °
(6) Swivel left (14) Travel right forward (22) Blade, bottom
(7) Bucket, bottom (15) Travel right rear (23) AUX2, High
(8) Bucket, rod (16) Travel left forward (24) AUX2, Low
RY9212052HYS0010US0
3-S38
Precautions on Assembly
1. Apply clean grease or hydraulic fluid to O-rings and their countersunk parts for mounting.
2. There should be no flaws in O-rings due to forming, and no marks or heat deformation incurred when handling.
3. If permanently deformed, O-rings will not straighten out. (Make sure that no flaws are incurred by an O-ring when
passing it through sharp angled sections of a spool.)
4. Do not turn over O-rings on installation. (Fouled O-rings are difficult to re-install and can easily result in oil
leakage.)
Before assembling, at the mating surface of each section, make sure no cleaning oil, hydraulic fluid, etc., is
adhered to the outer surface of the O-ring groove. (If you assemble with oil adhered to a mating surface, this may be
mistakenly recognized as oil leakage from that location when the machine is running.)
RY9212001HYS0140US0
Control Valve Disassembly / Assembly Procedures
1. Loosen the nuts on one side with a ring spanner.
26.5 to 29.4 N·m
Tightening torque Nut (four locations) 2.7 to 3.0 kgf·m
19.6 to 21.6 lbf·ft
2. Pull out each section with a tie rod, and arrange in order on a
workbench.
CAUTION
• When removing each section, take care not to lose the load
check valve and spring of the mating surface.
• Identify the load check valve and spring of each section so
that they are not mismatched.
• Apply a location mark for each section.
• Excess torque on threads will cause defective spool
operation. Therefore, be sure to use the specified torque.
• Take care over the direction of installation of each spool,
align with the holes and insert slowly.
(1) Nut (3) Spool
(2) Identification groove for spool
assembly orientation
RY9212001HYS0141US0
3-S39
(A) Outlet (E) Arm (I) Swing (a) Identification groove for
(B) AUX 1 (F) Boom (J) Blade spool assembly orientation
(C) Swivel (G) Travel right (K) AUX 2
(D) Bucket (H) Travel left (L) Inlet
RY9212052HYS0011US0
3-S40
Tightening
No. Name of part Q'ty
torque
(1) Outlet housing 1
(2) Spool 1
(3) Spring 1
(4) Metal washer 1
28 to 30 N·m
(5) Plug assembly 1 2.9 to 3.0 kgf·m
21 to 22 lbf·ft
28.4 to 30.4 N·m
(6) Plug 1 2.9 to 3.1 kgf·m
21 to 22.4 lbf·ft
O-ring
(7) 1
(JIS B 2401, 1B, P11)
(8) Plug 3
O-ring
(9) 1
(JIS B 2401, 1B, P18)
67.7 to 73.5 N·m
(10) Plug 1 6.9 to 7.49 kgf·m
50.0 to 54.2 lbf·ft
O-ring
(11) 1
(JIS B 2401, 1B, P7)
3-S41
Tightening
No. Name of part Q'ty
torque
(1) Valve housing 1
(2) Spool 1
(3) Cap 2
(4) Spring seat 2
(5) Spring seat 2
(6) Spring 2
8.8 to 10.8 N·m
(7) Socket head bolt 4 0.9 to 1.1 kgf·m
6.5 to 7.96 lbf·ft
(8) O-ring (S24, 1A) 2
(9) Spool 1
(10) Poppet 2
(11) Spring 2
67.7 to 73.5 N·m
(12) Plug 1 6.9 to 7.49 kgf·m
50.0 to 54.2 lbf·ft
(13) Poppet 1
O-ring
(14) 1
(JIS B 2401, 1B, P7)
O-ring
(15) 1
(JIS B 2401, 1A, G75)
O-ring
(16) 1
(JIS B 2401, 1B, P18)
3-S42
Tightening
No. Name of part Q'ty
torque
(1) Valve housing 1
(2) Spool 1
(3) Cap 2
(4) Spring seat 2
(5) Spring seat 2
(6) Spring 2
8.8 to 10.8 N·m
(7) Socket head bolt 4 0.9 to 1.1 kgf·m
6.5 to 7.96 lbf·ft
(8) O-ring (S24, 1A) 2
(9) Spool ASSY 1
(10) Poppet 2
(11) Spring 2
(12) Flange 1
O-ring
(13) 1
(JIS B 2401, 1B, P7)
O-ring
(14) 1
(JIS B 2401, 1A, G75)
O-ring
(15) 1
(JIS B 2401, 1B, P22)
30.4 to 32.4N·m
(16) Socket head bolt 2 3.1 to 3.3 kgf·m
22.5 to 23.8 lbf·ft
3-S43
Tightening
No. Name of part Q'ty
torque
(1) Valve housing 1
(2) Spool 1
(3) Cap 2
(4) Spring seat 2
(5) Spring seat 2
(6) Spring 2
8.8 to 10.8 N·m
(7) Socket head bolt 4 0.9 to 1.1 kgf·m
6.5 to 7.96 lbf·ft
(8) O-ring (S24, 1A) 2
(9) Spool 1
(10) Poppet 2
(11) Spring 2
(12) Flange 1
O-ring
(13) 1
(JIS B 2401, 1B, P7)
O-ring
(14) 1
(JIS B 2401, 1A, G75)
O-ring
(15) 1
(JIS B 2401, 1B, P22)
30.4 to 32.4N·m
(16) Socket head bolt 2 3.1 to 3.3 kgf·m
22.5 to 23.8 lbf·ft
3-S44
Tightening
No. Name of part Q'ty
torque
(1) Valve housing 1
(2) Spool 1
(3) Cap 2
(4) Spring seat 2
(5) Spring seat 2
(6) Spring 2
8.8 to 10.8 N·m
(7) Socket head bolt 4 0.9 to 1.1 kgf·m
6.5 to 7.96 lbf·ft
(8) O-ring 2
(9) Spool ASSY 1
(10) Poppet 2
(11) Spring 2
(12) Flange 1
O-ring
(13) 1
(JIS B 2401, 1B, P7)
O-ring
(14) 1
(JIS B 2401, 1A, G75)
O-ring
(15) 1
(JIS B 2401, 1B, P22)
30.4 to 32.4N·m
(16) Socket head bolt 2 3.1 to 3.3 kgf·m
22.5 to 23.8 lbf·ft
3-S45
Tightening
No. Name of part Q'ty
torque
(1) Valve housing 1
(2) Spool 1
(3) Cap 2
(4) Spring seat 2
(5) Spring seat 2
(6) Spring 2
8.8 to 10.8 N·m
(7) Socket head bolt 6 0.9 to 1.1 kgf·m
6.5 to 7.96 lbf·ft
(8) O-ring (S24, 1A) 2
(9) Spool ASSY 1
(10) Poppet 2
(11) Spring 2
O-ring
(12) 2
(JIS B 2401, 1B, P22)
O-ring
(13) 3
(JIS B 2401, 1B, P7)
(14) Anti-drift assembly 1
O-ring
(15) 1
(JIS B 2401, 1A, G75)
8.8 to 10.8 N·m
(16) Socket head bolt 5 0.9 to 1.1 kgf·m
6.5 to 7.96 lbf·ft
3-S46
Tightening
No. Name of part Q'ty
torque
(1) Valve housing 1
(2) Spool 1
(3) Cap 2
(4) Spring seat 2
(5) Spring seat 2
(6) Spring 2
8.8 to 10.8 N·m
(7) Socket head bolt 4 0.9 to 1.1 kgf·m
6.5 to 7.96 lbf·ft
(8) O-ring 2
(9) Spool 1
(10) Flange 1
O-ring
(11) 1
(JIS B 2401, 1B, P7)
O-ring
(12) 1
(JIS B 2401, 1A, G75)
O-ring
(13) 1
(JIS B 2401, 1B, P22)
30.4 to 32.4N·m
(14) Socket head bolt 2 3.1 to 3.3 kgf·m
22.5 to 23.8 lbf·ft
Tightening
No. Name of part Q'ty
torque
(1) Valve housing 1
(2) Spool 1
(3) Cap 2
(4) Spring seat 2
(5) Spring seat 2
(6) Spring 2
8.8 to 10.8 N·m
(7) Socket head bolt 4 0.9 to 1.1 kgf·m
6.5 to 7.96 lbf·ft
(8) O-ring 2
(9) Spool 1
(10) Flange 1
O-ring
(11) 1
(JIS B 2401, 1B, P7)
O-ring
(12) 1
(JIS B 2401, 1A, G75)
O-ring
(13) 1
(JIS B 2401, 1B, P22)
30.4 to 32.4N·m
(14) Socket head bolt 2 3.1 to 3.3 kgf·m
22.5 to 23.8 lbf·ft
3-S47
Tightening
No. Name of part Q'ty
torque
(1) Valve housing 1
(2) Spool 1
(3) Cap 2
(4) Spring seat 2
(5) Spring seat 2
(6) Spring 2
8.8 to 10.8 N·m
(7) Socket head bolt 4 0.9 to 1.1 kgf·m
6.5 to 7.96 lbf·ft
(8) O-ring 2
(9) Spool 1
(10) Poppet 2
(11) Spring 2
67.7 to 73.5 N·m
(12) Plug 1 6.9 to 7.49 kgf·m
50.0 to 54.2 lbf·ft
(13) Poppet 1
O-ring
(14) 1
(JIS B 2401, 1B, P7)
O-ring
(15) 1
(JIS B 2401, 1A, G75)
O-ring
(16) 1
(JIS B 2401, 1B, P18)
3-S48
Tightening
No. Name of part Q'ty
torque
(1) Valve housing 1
(2) Spool 1
(3) Cap 2
(4) Spring seat 2
(5) Spring seat 2
(6) Spring 2
8.8 to 10.8 N·m
(7) Socket head bolt 4 0.9 to 1.1 kgf·m
6.5 to 7.96 lbf·ft
(8) O-ring (S24, 1A) 2
(9) Spool 1
(10) Poppet 2
(11) Spring 2
67.7 to 73.5 N·m
(12) Plug 1 6.9 to 7.49 kgf·m
50.0 to 54.2 lbf·ft
(13) Poppet 1
O-ring
(14) 1
(JIS B 2401, 1B, P7)
O-ring
(15) 1
(JIS B 2401, 1A, G75)
O-ring
(16) 1
(JIS B 2401, 1B, P18)
3-S49
Tightening
No. Name of part Q'ty
torque
(1) Valve housing 1
(2) Spool 1
(3) Cap 2
(4) Spring seat 2
(5) Spring seat 2
(6) Spring 2
8.8 to 10.8 N·m
(7) Socket head bolt 4 0.9 to 1.1 kgf·m
6.5 to 7.96 lbf·ft
(8) O-ring (S24, 1A) 2
(9) Spool 1
(10) Poppet 2
(11) Spring 2
67.7 to 73.5 N·m
(12) Plug 1 6.9 to 7.49 kgf·m
50.0 to 54.2 lbf·ft
(13) Poppet 1
O-ring
(14) 1
(JIS B 2401, 1B, P7)
O-ring
(15) 1
(JIS B 2401, 1A, G75)
O-ring
(16) 1
(JIS B 2401, 1B, P18)
3-S50
3-S51
Tightening
No. Name of part Q'ty
torque
(1) Outlet housing 1
(2) Spool 1
(3) Spring 1
(4) Metal washer 1
28 to 30 N·m
(5) Plug assembly 1 2.9 to 3.0 kgf·m
21 to 22 lbf·ft
28.4 to 30.4 N·m
(6) Plug 1 2.9 to 3.1 kgf·m
21 to 22.4 lbf·ft
O-ring
(7) 1
(JIS B 2401, 1B, P11)
(8) Plug 3
O-ring
(9) 1
(JIS B 2401, 1B, P18)
67.7 to 73.5 N·m
(10) Plug 1 6.9 to 7.49 kgf·m
50.0 to 54.2 lbf·ft
O-ring
(11) 1
(JIS B 2401, 1B, P7)
3-S52
Tightening
No. Name of part Q'ty
torque
(1) Valve housing 1
(2) Spool 1
(3) Cap 2
(4) Spring seat 2
(5) Spring seat 2
(6) Spring 2
8.8 to 10.8 N·m
(7) Socket head bolt 4 0.9 to 1.1 kgf·m
6.5 to 7.96 lbf·ft
(8) O-ring (S24, 1A) 2
(9) Spool 1
(10) Poppet 2
(11) Spring 2
(12) Plug 1
67.7 to 73.5 N·m
(13) Poppet 1 6.9 to 7.49 kgf·m
50.0 to 54.2 lbf·ft
O-ring
(14) 1
(JIS B 2401, 1B, P7)
O-ring
(15) 1
(JIS B 2401, 1A, G75)
O-ring
(16) 1
(JIS B 2401, 1B, P18)
3-S53
Tightening
No. Name of part Q'ty
torque
(1) Valve housing 1
(2) Spool 1
(3) Cap 2
(4) Spring seat 2
(5) Spring seat 2
(6) Spring 2
8.8 to 10.8 N·m
(7) Socket head bolt 4 0.9 to 1.1 kgf·m
6.5 to 7.96 lbf·ft
(8) O-Ring 2
(9) Spool ASSY 1
(10) Poppet 2
(11) Spring 2
(12) Flange 1
O-ring
(13) 1
(JIS B 2401, 1B, P7)
O-ring
(14) 1
(JIS B 2401, 1A, G75)
O-ring
(15) 1
(JIS B 2401, 1B, P22)
30.4 to 32.4 N·m
(16) Socket head bolt 2 3.1 to 3.3 kgf·m
22.5 to 23.8 lbf·ft
3-S54
Tightening
No. Name of part Q'ty
torque
(1) Valve housing 1
(2) Spool 1
(3) Cap 2
(4) Spring seat 2
(5) Spring seat 2
(6) Spring 2
8.8 to 10.8 N·m
(7) Socket head bolt 4 0.9 to 1.1 kgf·m
6.5 to 7.96 lbf·ft
(8) O-Ring 2
(9) Spool 1
(10) Poppet 2
(11) Spring 2
(12) Flange 1
O-ring
(13) 1
(JIS B 2401, 1B, P7)
O-ring
(14) 1
(JIS B 2401, 1A, G75)
O-ring
(15) 1
(JIS B 2401, 1B, P22)
30.4 to 32.4 N·m
(16) Socket head bolt 2 3.1 to 3.3 kgf·m
22.5 to 23.8 lbf·ft
3-S55
Tightening
No. Name of part Q'ty
torque
(1) Valve housing 1
(2) Spool 1
(3) Cap 2
(4) Spring seat 2
(5) Spring seat 2
(6) Spring 2
8.8 to 10.8 N·m
(7) Socket head bolt 4 0.9 to 1.1 kgf·m
6.5 to 7.96 lbf·ft
(8) O-Ring 2
(9) Spool ASSY 1
(10) Poppet 2
(11) Spring 2
(12) Flange 1
O-ring
(13) 1
(JIS B 2401, 1B, P7)
O-ring
(14) 1
(JIS B 2401, 1A, G75)
O-ring
(15) 1
(JIS B 2401, 1B, P22)
30.4 to 32.4 N·m
(16) Socket head bolt 2 3.1 to 3.3 kgf·m
22.5 to 23.8 lbf·ft
3-S56
Tightening
No. Name of part Q'ty
torque
(1) Valve housing 1
(2) Spool 1
(3) Cap 2
(4) Spring seat 2
(5) Spring seat 2
(6) Spring 2
8.8 to 10.8 N·m
(7) Socket head bolt 6 0.9 to 1.1 kgf·m
6.5 to 7.96 lbf·ft
(8) O-ring (S24, 1A) 2
(9) Spool ASSY 1
(10) Poppet 2
(11) Spring 2
O-ring
(12) 2
(JIS B 2401, 1B, P22)
O-ring
(13) 3
(JIS B 2401, 1B, P7)
(14) Anti-drift assembly 1
O-ring
(15) 1
(JIS B 2401, 1A, G75)
8.8 to 10.8 N·m
(16) Socket head bolt 5 0.9 to 1.1 kgf·m
6.5 to 7.96 lbf·ft
28 to 30 N·m
(17) Valve ASSY 1 2.9 to 3.0 kgf·m
21 to 22 lbf·ft
3-S57
Tightening
No. Name of part Q'ty
torque
(1) Valve housing 1
(2) Spool 1
(3) Cap 1
(4) Cap 1
(5) Plate (spring) 1
(6) Seat (spring) 2
(7) Spring 1
(8) O-Ring 2
8.8 to 10.8 N·m
(9) Hex socket bolt 3 0.9 to 1.1 kgf·m
6.5 to 7.96 lbf·ft
(10) O-Ring 1
21.6 to 23.6 N·m
(11) Plug, assembly 1 2.2 to 2.4 kgf·m
16.0 to 17.4 lbf·ft
(12) O-Ring 1
8.8 to 10.8 N·m
(13) Bolt (socket head) 2 0.9 to 1.1 kgf·m
6.5 to 7.96 lbf·ft
Tightening
No. Name of part Q'ty
torque
(1) Valve housing 1
(2) Spool 1
(3) Cap 2
(4) Spring seat 2
(5) Spring seat 2
(6) Spring 2
30.4 to 32.4 N·m
(7) Plug 1 3.1 to 3.3 kgf·m
22.5 to 23.8 lbf·ft
(8) O-Ring 1
(9) O-ring (S24, 1A) 2
8.8 to 10.8 N·m
(10) Socket head bolt 4 0.9 to 1.1 kgf·m
6.5 to 7.96 lbf·ft
O-ring
(11) 1
(JIS B 2401, 1A, G70)
RY9212032HYS0024US0
3-S58
Tightening
No. Name of part Q'ty
torque
(1) Valve housing 1
(2) Spool 1
(3) Cap 2
(4) Spring seat 2
(5) Spring seat 2
(6) Spring 2
30.4 to 32.4 N·m
(7) Plug 2 3.1 to 3.3 kgf·m
22.5 to 23.8 lbf·ft
(8) O-Ring 2
(9) O-ring (S24, 1A) 2
8.8 to 10.8 N·m
(10) Socket head bolt 4 0.9 to 1.1 kgf·m
6.5 to 7.96 lbf·ft
O-ring
(11) 1
(JIS B 2401, 1A, G70)
RY9212032HYS0025US0
Tightening
No. Name of part Q'ty
torque
(1) Valve housing 1
(2) Spool 1
(3) Cap 1
(4) Body assembly 1
(5) Spring seat 1
(6) Spring seat 1
(7) Spring 1
(8) O-ring (S24, 1A) 1
30.4 to 32.4 N·m
(9) Plug 1 3.1 to 3.3 kgf·m
22.5 to 23.8 lbf·ft
(10) O-Ring 1
(11) Spring 1
(12) Poppet 1
8.8 to 10.8 N·m
(13) Socket head bolt 2 0.9 to 1.1 kgf·m
6.5 to 7.96 lbf·ft
8.8 to 10.8 N·m
(14) Socket head bolt 2 0.9 to 1.1 kgf·m
6.5 to 7.96 lbf·ft
3-S59
Tightening
No. Name of part Q'ty
torque
(1) Valve housing 1
(2) Spool 1
(3) Cap 2
(4) Spring seat 2
(5) Spring seat 2
(6) Spring 2
(7) Poppet 1
(8) Spring 1
30.4 to 32.4 N·m
(9) Plug 1 3.1 to 3.3 kgf·m
22.5 to 23.8 lbf·ft
(10) O-ring (S24, 1A) 2
(11) O-Ring 2
8.8 to 10.8 N·m
(12) Socket head bolt 4 0.9 to 1.1 kgf·m
6.5 to 7.96 lbf·ft
O-ring
(13) 1
(JIS B 2401, 1A, G70)
30.4 to 32.4 N·m
(14) Plug 1 3.1 to 3.3 kgf·m
22.5 to 23.8 lbf·ft
69 to 78 N·m
(15) Shut-off valve 2 7.0 to 8.0 kgf·m
51 to 57 lbf·ft
3-S60
Tightening
No. Name of part Q'ty
torque
(1) Valve housing 1
(2) Spool 1
(3) Cap 2
(4) Spring seat 2
(5) Spring seat 2
(6) Spring 2
(7) Poppet 1
(8) Spring 1
30.4 to 32.4 N·m
(9) Plug 1 3.1 to 3.3 kgf·m
22.5 to 23.8 lbf·ft
(10) O-Ring 2
(11) O-ring (S24, 1A) 2
8.8 to 10.8 N·m
(12) Socket head bolt 4 0.9 to 1.1 kgf·m
6.5 to 7.96 lbf·ft
O-ring
(13) 1
(JIS B 2401, 1A, G70)
30.4 to 32.4 N·m
(14) Plug 1 3.1 to 3.3 kgf·m
22.5 to 23.8 lbf·ft
3-S61
Tightening
No. Name of part Q'ty
torque
(1) Valve housing 1
(2) Spool 1
(3) Cap 2
(4) Spring seat 2
(5) Spring seat 2
(6) Spring 2
(7) Poppet 1
(8) Spring 1
30.4 to 32.4 N·m
(9) Plug 1 3.1 to 3.3 kgf·m
22.5 to 23.8 lbf·ft
(10) O-ring (S24, 1A) 2
(11) O-Ring 2
8.8 to 10.8 N·m
(12) Socket head bolt 4 0.9 to 1.1 kgf·m
6.5 to 7.96 lbf·ft
O-ring
(13) 1
(JIS B 2401, 1A, G70)
30.4 to 32.4 N·m
(14) Plug 1 3.1 to 3.3 kgf·m
22.5 to 23.8 lbf·ft
69 to 78 N·m
(15) Shut-off valve 2 7.0 to 8.0 kgf·m
51 to 57 lbf·ft
RY9212032HYS0029US0
3-S62
3. SWIVEL MOTOR
[1] REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION OF THE SWIVEL MOTOR
CAUTION
• When removing a hydraulic device after operating the mini-excavator, lower the bucket and blade to the
ground and turn off the engine.
• Each of the devices and the hydraulic oil are hot and under high pressure immediately after operating the
mini-excavator. If the hydraulic oil reached a high operating temperature, it may cause a burn.
• Oil gushing out under pressure has enough force to pierce your skin and may cause you injury. Always
allow the temperature to drop and relieve any remaining pressure prior to working to remove any
hydraulic equipment.
RY9212001MBS0004US0
Removing the cab
1. Put the bucket on the ground and stop the engine.
Remove the cab.
(Refer to the chapter Cab Removal and Installation.)
Removing ducts
1. Remove the cover (duct) (1) and the duct ASSY (2).
(1) Step
RY9212001HYS0171US0
3-S63
IMPORTANT
• Apply a threadlock (Loctite #271).
259.9 to 304.0 N·m
Tightening torque Motor ASSY (swivel) 26.5 to 31.0 kgf·m
191.7 to 224 lbf·ft
(1) Hydraulic hose (3/8P Travel) (4) Hydraulic hose (5/8Makeup) (a) Motor ASSY (swivel) (d) Valve ASSY (PV swing)
(2) Hydraulic hose (5) Hydraulic hose (1/2SM-RH) (b) Valve ASSY (PV AUX1) (e) Control Valve
(3/8SM-LOCK) (6) Hose (drain, swivel) (c) Valve ASSY (PV Travel) (f) Coupler (Block PP)
(3) Hydraulic hose (1/2SM-LH)
RY9212001HYS0173US0
3-S64
(1) Motor, ASSY (swivel) (5) Pipe joint (T, G2, G2-G2) (a) Swivel right (d) P-block (tank)
(2) Pipe joint (S G4, G4) (6) Pipe joint (L, G1/4-G3/8) (b) Swivel left (e) Travel pilot V and swing
(3) Pipe joint (S G4, G4) (7) Pipe joint (L, G2-13) (c) Apply grease to and install pilot V
(4) Pipe joint (S G4, G4) the rabbeted flange and the (f) Front of machine
pinion.
RY9212001HYS0175US0
3-S65
3-S66
RY9212001HYS0177US0
3-S67
IMPORTANT
• Apply grease to the lip and circumference of the oil seal.
2. Press the outer race of the tapering roller bearing all the way
into the gear case (6).
3-S68
IMPORTANT
• Be careful of its direction when pressing the inner race of
the tapering roller bearing (5) onto the shaft (1).
• After installing it, encapsulate the inner race of the tapering
roller bearing with grease.
IMPORTANT
• Do not scratch the oil seal.
3-S69
IMPORTANT
• Be careful to install the inner race facing the right direction.
• After installing it, rotate the shaft by hand.
• Select and install a spacer (9) so that the gap is between 0
to 0.15mm (0.006 in.).
IMPORTANT
• Be careful to install the gears (planetary 2) facing the right
direction.
• Install the gears (planetary 2) so the end without an
indentation faces the holder 2.
• Install the plates (thrust 2) and external circlips (15) with
the R face down.
3-S70
IMPORTANT
• Be careful to install the gears (planetary 1) and (drive)
facing the right direction.
• Install the gear (drive) so the indented face is toward the
holder 1.
• Install the gear (planetary 1) so the indented face is toward
the plate (thrust).
• Apply grease to the O-ring.
11. Measure the distance A between the top of the gear (planetary
1) and the top of the gear case.
IMPORTANT
• Select the appropriate plate (thrust) from the table below to
suit the measurement of distance A.
Distance A Part to Install Thickness
5.50 to 6.00 mm 1.8 mm
FD411-1727
0.22 to 0.24 in. 0.07 in.
6.00 to 6.60 mm 2.3 mm
FD411-1728
0.24 to 0.26 in. 0.09 in.
6.60 to 6.90 mm 2.9 mm
FD411-1729
0.26 to 0.27 in. 0.11 in.
6.90 to 7.40 mm 3.2 mm
FD411-1730
0.27 to 0.29 in. 0.13 in.
3-S71
IMPORTANT
• When installing the bearing (57) in the housing (motor,
valve), install it so its inscription is visible.
• Dip the thrust plate (59) in hydraulic oil and install it so the
beveled side faces the housing.
15. Install the metal washer (spring) (66), spring CY (67), metal
washer (spring) (68) and internal circlip (69) in the cylinder block
(65).
IMPORTANT
• Install the internal circlip (69) so its R face is toward the
piston.
• Apply grease to the pin and install it in the holder (retainer)
(61) and the plate (retainer) (60) in order.
3-S72
IMPORTANT
• Be careful not to drop the pin.
• Dip the whole ASSY in hydraulic oil and then install it.
• After installing the ASSY, check and make sure the plate
(friction) is not tilted.
• Press on the cylinder block sub-assembly B1 and make
sure the spring CY is working.
18. Check the O-ring on the gear case side and install the housing
(motor, valves) on the gear case.
19. Fasten it with the hex socket bolts (25).
102.9 to 117.6 N·m
Tightening torque Hex socket bolt (25) 10.5 to 12.0 kgf·m
75.9 to 86.7 lbf·ft
• Tool to use : M10 hex socket
IMPORTANT
• Apply grease to the O-ring.
3-S73
IMPORTANT
• Apply grease to the O-ring.
24. Install the ball bearing (75) on the cover (motor) (84).
25. Install the plate (valve) (74) on the cover (84).
IMPORTANT
• When installing the ball bearing (75), install it so its
inscription is visible.
• Apply grease on the plate (74) and stick it to the cover (84).
IMPORTANT
• Be careful not to drop any valves (plate).
102.9 to 117.6 N·m
Tightening torque Hex socket bolt (83) 10.5 to 12.0 kgf·m
75.9 to 86.7 lbf·ft
• Tool to use : M10 hex socket
(83) Hex socket bolt (M12)
RY9212001HYS0195US0
3-S74
29. Apply hydraulic oil to the piston (shockless) (36) and install it.
3-S75
3-S76
4. SWIVEL JOINT
[1] SWIVEL JOINT REMOVAL & INSTALLATION
CAUTION
• When removing a hydraulic device after operating the mini-excavator, lower the bucket and blade to the
ground and turn off the engine.
• Each of the devices and the hydraulic oil are hot and under high pressure immediately after operating the
mini-excavator. If the hydraulic oil reached a high operating temperature, it may cause a burn.
• Oil gushing out under pressure has enough force to pierce your skin and may cause you injury. Always
allow the temperature to drop and relieve any remaining pressure prior to working to remove any
hydraulic equipment.
RY9212001MBS0004US0
Stabilizing the Mini-excavator
1. Position the mini-excavator on hard, level ground, operating the
equipment and blade to lift the body.
DANGER
• Put blocks under the crawler to prevent the mini-excavator
from lowering.
(1) Block
RY9212001HYS0199US0
Attaching the vacuum pump
1. Attach the breather hose (1) of the hydraulic tank to the vacuum
pump (2), and apply vacuum pressure to the hydraulic tank.
3-S77
2. Rotate the swivel joint, remove it from the track frame and
slowly lower it.
(1) Body
(2) Collar
(3) Packing (U)
(4) O-Ring
(5) Seal
(6) Shaft
(7) Collar
(8) External circlip
(9) Plug (PT1/4)
(10) Hex socket plug
(11) Hex socket bolt
(12) Cover (bottom, RJ)
(13) O-Ring
(14) Bolt (M10 x 25)
RY9212001HYS0205US0
3-S78
IMPORTANT
• Apply a threadlock (Loctite #271).
196.1 to 225.6 N·m
Tightening torque Hex socket bolt (11) 20.0 to 23.0 kgf·m
144.6 to 166.4 lbf·ft
3. Tightening torque of cover (bottom, RJ) (12) mounting bolt (14)
48.1 to 55.9 N·m
Tightening torque Bolt (14) 4.9 to 5.7 kgf·m
35.5 to 41.2 lbf·ft
3-S79
IMPORTANT
• Apply a threadlock (Locktite #271).
166.7 to 196.1 N·m
Tightening torque Bolt (5) 17.0 to 20.0 kgf·m
123.0 to 144.6 lbf·ft
RY9212052HYS0116US0
3-S80
5. TRAVEL MOTOR
[1] REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION OF THE TRAVEL MOTOR
CAUTION
• When removing a hydraulic device after operating the mini-excavator, lower the bucket and blade to the
ground and turn off the engine.
• Each of the devices and the hydraulic oil are hot and under high pressure immediately after operating the
mini-excavator. If the hydraulic oil reached a high operating temperature, it may cause a burn.
• Oil gushing out under pressure has enough force to pierce your skin and may cause you injury. Always
allow the temperature to drop and relieve any remaining pressure prior to working to remove any
hydraulic equipment.
RY9212001MBS0004US0
Removing the travel motor
1. Remove the crawler track. Refer to the chapter Crawler Track
for the removal and installation of the crawler track.
DANGER
• Jack up the mini-excavator with the front-end and the blade
and place timbers under the frame.
RY9212032HYS0082US0
2. Position the swing and swivel as in the photo at left and lower
the bucket and blade to the floor.
RY9212032HYS0083US0
3. Remove the three cover mounting bolts (2) and take the cover
(1) off.
3-S81
IMPORTANT
• Apply a threadlock (Loctite #271).
166.7 to 196.1 N·m
Tightening torque Motor, ASSY (wheel) (1) 17 to 20 kgf·m
123.0 to 144.6 lbf·ft
IMPORTANT
• Apply a threadlock (Loctite #271).
166.7 to 196.1 N·m
Tightening torque Sprocket (2) 17 to 20 kgf·m
123.0 to 144.6 lbf·ft
3-S82
RY9212001HYS0214US0
3-S83
3-S84
RY9212001HYS0216US0
3-S85
IMPORTANT
• After removing the cover, remove the spring pin from the
cover.
3-S86
3-S87
(19) Collar
RY9212001HYS0229US0
3-S88
18. Tap the gear case (6) alternately on its sides with a plastic
hammer.
3-S89
20. Remove the seal (24) from the gear case side.
(24) Seal
RY9212001HYS0236US0
21. Remove the seal (24) from the flange holder side.
(24) Seal
RY9212001HYS0237US0
(7) Plug
RY9212001HYS0238US0
IMPORTANT
• Do not lose any of the balls.
• If you fail to remove even one of the balls, the bearing
cannot be removed, so keep close track of the balls.
(25) Ball
RY9212001HYS0239US0
3-S90
3-S91
CAUTION
• There is little room for the wrench (or socket), so be careful
not to let it slip.
3-S92
IMPORTANT
• Be very careful because using force to insert a slotted
screwdriver may scratch the body (counterbalance).
RY9212001HYS0248US0
9. Remove the valve plate (valve) (53) and O-rings (29) & (60).
10. Remove the eight (NB1) springs (50) and four (NB2) springs
(51).
3-S93
CAUTION
• Be careful not to blast too much air as doing so may cause
the piston brake to go flying.
• The brake release oil passage hole is the larger of the bolt
holes (3 bolts), so make sure you use the correct one.
(a) 2-speed switch oil passage hole (b) Brake release oil passage hole
RY9212001HYS0251US0
3-S94
17. Turn the assembly platform over and remove the oil seal (32).
When you removed the shaft, if the ball bearing did not come off,
remove it together now.
Enlarged view
RY9212001HYS0258US0
3-S95
2. After installing it, check and make sure the groove (a) around
the circumference of the bearing comes right to the center.
(25) Ball
RY9212001HYS0259US0
4. Wrap the plug (7) with plumber's tape and install it.
(7) Plug
RY9212001HYS0260US0
5. Set the floating seal installation tool (a) on the gear case (6).
3-S96
(24) Seal
RY9212001HYS0261US0
8. Install the seal in the gear case with the floating seal installation
tool (b).
9. Apply a little gear oil to the sliding surface of the seal. (4 places,
every 90º)
(24) Seal
RY9212001HYS0262US0
3-S97
(24) Seal
RY9212001HYS0263US0
13. Install the seal on the holder (flange) with the floating seal
installation tool.
14. Apply a little gear oil to the sliding surface of the seal. (4 places,
every 90º)
(24) Seal
RY9212001HYS0264US0
3-S98
IMPORTANT
• Be careful that it faces the right direction.
• Install with the R face down.
20. Install the set screws (27) for preventing rotation of the nut
(ring).
3-S99
(19) Collar
RY9212001HYS0271US0
25. Install the plate (thrust, B2) (18) and then the 4 axle snap rings
(17).
3-S100
(14) Holder
RY9212001HYS0276US0
(12) Collar
RY9212001HYS0278US0
3-S101
IMPORTANT
• Be careful that it faces the right direction.
• Install with the convex side up.
3-S102
Measure the distance between the gear case tooth surface and
the gear case.
This is measurement B (B).
IMPORTANT
• Apply grease to the O-ring.
• Install so the hole in the gear case aligns with the hole in
the cover.
3-S103
IMPORTANT
• Be careful to orient the split in the spring pins correctly.
• The split must face to the side.
(1) Plug
RY9212001HYS0286US0
IMPORTANT
• Take care to face the oil seal the right direction.
• Apply grease to its lip and circumference.
3-S104
IMPORTANT
• Face the bearing so the inscription is up.
• Apply grease to the outside of the bearing.
(33) Bearing
RY9212001HYS0287US0
IMPORTANT
• The spring comes out easily, so apply some grease to it.
• Press the piston ASSY (B2) down and make sure it moves
smoothly.
(35) Ball
RY9212001HYS0289US0
5. Install the shaft (34) and then the swash-plate (variable) (36).
IMPORTANT
• Make sure the piston ASSY moves smoothly.
3-S105
8. Install the piston ASSY (38) into the plate (retainer)(40) and
then install it into the cylinder block.
IMPORTANT
• Apply hydraulic oil to the pistons.
• Make sure the pistons move smoothly.
IMPORTANT
• Turn the disassembly / assembly platform on its side.
3-S106
IMPORTANT
• Turn the assembly platform so it faces up.
IMPORTANT
• Apply grease to the O-rings (47) (52).
3-S107
IMPORTANT
• The spool itself slides smoothly.
• Apply hydraulic oil to the spool.
3-S108
(78) Plug
RY9212001HYS0304US0
IMPORTANT
• The spool itself slides smoothly.
• Be careful to install the spool in the right direction.
• Apply hydraulic oil to the spool.
Install so the spool side is toward the side with the hole.
21. Install the pipe connector (2-speed) and the plug (83).
(83) Plug
RY9212001HYS0306US0
3-S109
IMPORTANT
• There are many O-rings, so be careful not to forget to install
any of them.
IMPORTANT
• Apply hydraulic oil to the entire spool.
• The spool itself slides smoothly.
(94) Plug
RY9212001HYS0309US0
3-S110
3-S111
RY9212001HYS0310US0
3-S112
(7) Plug
RY9212001HYS0312US0
3. Remove the two plugs and replace them with eyebolts, then put
the rod through them.
(1) Plug
RY9212001HYS0313US0
5. Turn the eyebolt rod, rotating the cover until you can see the tip
of the wire (5) coming from the plug hole.
Use needle-nose pliers to pull the wire out of the plug hole.
(5) Wire
RY9212001HYS0315US0
3-S113
NOTE
• It is easiest to use regular pliers once the wire is out far
enough for them to grasp it. (as regular pliers get a better
grip than needle-nose pliers)
(5) Wire
RY9212001HYS0316US0
7. Remove the eyebolts, attach the cover removal tool and knock
it up to remove the cover.
3-S114
3-S115
IMPORTANT
• If the flathead screws are too tight to remove, heat them up
with a heat gun or the like.
3-S116
21. Use removal bolts to raise the gear case up higher than the
flange holder.
IMPORTANT
• Tighten the removal bolts equally.
NOTE
• Refer to [U48-4 TRAVEL MOTOR DISASSEMBLY /
ASSEMBLY PROCEDURES] in case removal bolts are not
available.
RY9212052HYS0102US0
3-S117
24. Remove the seal (25) from the flange holder side.
IMPORTANT
• Do not lose any of the balls.
• If you fail to remove even one of the balls, the bearing
cannot be removed, so keep close track of the balls.
3-S118
IMPORTANT
• Replace O-rings with new ones during reassembly.
IMPORTANT
• Check to make sure there are not any scratches around the
circumference of the spools.
3-S119
IMPORTANT
• There is little room for the wrench (or socket), so be careful
not to let it slip.
• Check to make sure there are not any scratches around the
circumference of the spools.
IMPORTANT
• Be very careful because using force to insert a slotted
screwdriver may scratch the baseplate.
RY9212001HYS0343US0
7. Remove the plate (valve) (53) and O-rings (28) and (52).
3-S120
CAUTION
• Be careful because if you blast air into the passage, the
piston brake may come flying off.
(a) Brake release oil passage hole (b) 2-speed switch oil passage hole
RY9212001HYS0346US0
(36) Swash-plate
RY9212001HYS0348US0
3-S121
(35) Ball
RY9212001HYS0350US0
IMPORTANT
• When you removed the shaft, if the ball bearing had not
been removed, remove them together now.
Enlarged view
RY9212001HYS0352US0
3-S122
2. After installing it, check and make sure the groove (a) around
the circumference of the bearing comes right to the center.
4. Wrap the plug (7) with plumber's tape and install it.
(7) Plug
RY9212001HYS0354US0
5. Set the floating seal installation tool (a) on the gear case (6).
3-S123
(25) Seal
RY9212001HYS0355US0
8. Install the seal in the gear case with the floating seal installation
tool (b).
3-S124
(25) Seal
RY9212001HYS0357US0
13. Install the seal on the holder (flange) with the floating seal
installation tool.
14. Apply a little gear oil on the sliding surface. (4 places, every 90º)
3-S125
19. Install the plugs (2) for preventing rotation of the nut (ring).
3-S126
IMPORTANT
• Install with the R face down.
3-S127
(14) Holder
RY9212001HYS0371US0
IMPORTANT
• Install with the R face down.
3-S128
34. Measure the distance between the edges of the holder and the
gear case.
This is measurement A (A).
35. Measure the distance between the gear case tooth surface and
the edge of the gear case.
This is measurement B (B).
3-S129
Ex.)
23.1 mm (0.909 in.) – 21.5 mm (0.846 in.) = 1.6 mm (0.063 in.)
Measurement C Plate thickness t
0.6 to 1.1 mm 1.8 mm
0.02 to 0.043 in. 0.071 in.
1.2 to1.7 mm 2.3 mm
0.047 to 0.067 in. 0.091 in.
1.8 to 2.3 mm 2.8 mm
0.071 to 0.091 in. 0.094 in.
RY9212001HYS0379US0
37. Install the selected plate and kit (thrust) (8).
IMPORTANT
• Apply grease to the O-ring.
• Install so the hole in the gear case aligns with the notched
groove in the cover.
40. Bend the last 6 mm (0.2 in.) of a wire 90º and insert the tip of
the wire into the hole in the gear case.
3-S130
(7) Plug
RY9212001HYS0385US0
43. After installing the cover, rotate the assembly platform 90 and
pour in gear oil.
Fill it with gear oil until it flows out of the inspection port and then
install the plug.
(1) Plug
RY9212001HYS0386US0
IMPORTANT
• Take care to face the oil seal the right direction.
• Apply grease to its lip and circumference.
3-S131
IMPORTANT
• Face the ball bearing so the inscription is up.
• Apply grease to the circumference of the ball bearing.
IMPORTANT
• The spring comes out easily, so apply some grease to it.
• Press the piston down and make sure it moves smoothly.
(35) Ball
RY9212001HYS0389US0
IMPORTANT
• After installing them, make sure the swash-plate moves
smoothly.
3-S132
IMPORTANT
• Apply grease to the pins.
8. Install the piston ASSY (38) into the retainer plate (40) and then
install it into the cylinder block.
IMPORTANT
• Apply hydraulic oil to the pistons.
• Make sure the pistons move smoothly.
9. Install the sub-assy of the cylinder block and the disc (46) into
the flange holder.
IMPORTANT
• Turn the disassembly / assembly platform on its side.
(46) Disc
RY9212001HYS0394US0
10. Check and make sure that the cylinder block's sliding surface
sinks below the edge of the holder.
IMPORTANT
• Turn the disassembly / assembly platform on its side.
RY9212001HYS0395US0
3-S133
IMPORTANT
• Apply grease to the O-ring.
14. Install the plate (valve) and O-ring on the base plate.
IMPORTANT
• Take care to install the plate (valve) facing the right
direction.
• Apply grease on the back of the plate (valve) so it does not
fall off the base plate.
• Apply grease to the O-ring.
IMPORTANT
• Be careful so the plate (valve) does not fall off.
• Tighten the hex socket bolts in a criss-cross pattern.
121.6 to 135.4 N·m
Tightening torque Hex socket bolt 12.4 to 13.8 kgf·m
89.69 to 99.87 lbf·ft
• Tool to use : M10 hex socket
(77) Baseplate (78) Hex socket bolt
RY9212001HYS0400US0
3-S134
IMPORTANT
• The spool itself slides smoothly.
• Apply hydraulic oil to the spool.
IMPORTANT
• The spool itself slides smoothly.
• Apply hydraulic oil to the spool.
49 to 58.8 N·m
Tightening torque Plug 5.0 to 6.0 kgf·m
36.0 to 43.4 lbf·ft
• Tool to use : M8 hex socket, M22 socket wrench
3-S135
IMPORTANT
• Be careful not to forget to install the O-ring.
• Apply grease to the O-ring.
35 to 38.8 N·m
Tightening torque Hex socket bolt 3.6 to 4.0 kgf·m
25.8 to 28.6 lbf·ft
• Tool to use : M6 hex socket
(87) Hex socket bolt (88) Valve body
RY9212001HYS0407US0
23. Install the spool (89) and the spring seat (86).
IMPORTANT
• The spool itself slides smoothly.
• Apply hydraulic oil to the spool.
49 to 58.8 N·m
Tightening torque Plug (83) 5.0 to 6.0 kgf·m
36.0 to 43.4 lbf·ft
• Tool to use : M8 hex socket
3-S136
No. in
Name of part
Figure
(a) Floating seal installation tool [Guide (for housing)]
(b) Floating seal installation tool (pusher)
(c) Floating seal installation tool [Guide (for flange holder)]
(d) Cover removal tool
(e) Ring nut socket
(f) Removal bolts (M10 x 2.0)
(g) Oil seal installation tool
RY9212001HYS0410US0
(a) Floating seal installation tool [Guide (for housing)]
3-S137
(1) Tempered
RY9212052HYS0033US0
(1) Weld
RY9212052HYS0034US0
3-S138
A M14 x P2.0
B M14 nut
C 250 mm, 9.84 in.
D 5 mm, 0.5 in.
RY9212052HYS0035US0
3-S139
6. HYDRAULIC CYLINDER
[1] HYDRAULIC CYLINDER DISASSEMBLY / ASSEMBLY
PROCEDURES
(1) Cylinder Components
Boom Cylinder
RY9212032HYS0030US0
3-S140
RY9212032HYS0031US0
3-S141
4. Pull out the piston rod assembly (2) together with the cylinder
head (3), and place on a board.
IMPORTANT
• Check whether or not the pipe cap has been removed.
• Provide the port on the cylinder head side with an oil
receptacle.
• Draw the piston rod assembly (2) out horizontally while
keeping it held, to avoid dropping it and causing damage to
parts immediately after it is withdrawn.
(2) Piston rod ASSY (3) Cylinder head
RY9212032HYS0035US0
5. Fasten the piston rod assembly (2) in a vice across the bolt
width and use a cushioning material.
IMPORTANT
• Place the rod on a block of wood.
3-S142
IMPORTANT
• The set screw (19) is caulked in two locations. Use a hand
drill or similar device to remove the caulking, then loosen
the set screw (19).
• After removing, use a hand tap (M8 x 1.25) to carry off the
piston side.
• If the set screw (19) is damaged on removal, replace it with
a new one.
(16) Piston
RY9212001HYS0433US0
8. Remove the piston (16), cushion bearing (15) and cylinder head
(3) in that order.
3-S143
IMPORTANT
• Do not use seals once removed.
(17) Seal ring, O-ring (a) Slotted screwdriver
(18) Slide ring
RY9212001HYS0439US0
10. Remove the O-rings (7) (9) and backup ring (8) of the cylinder
head (3).
IMPORTANT
• If removal is difficult, use a screwdriver, taking care not to
damage the cylinder head.
• Do not use seals once removed.
(3) Cylinder head (8) Backup ring
(7) O-Ring (9) O-Ring
RY9212032HYS0037US0
IMPORTANT
• Do not use seals once removed.
12. Lift the U-ring (5) using a screwdriver, and remove it from the
cylinder head (3).
IMPORTANT
• Do not use seals once removed.
13. Lift the buffer ring (21) with a screwdriver, and remove it from
the cylinder head (3).
IMPORTANT
• Do not use seals once removed.
3-S144
IMPORTANT
• Do not use seals once removed.
15. Lightly tap out the bushing (4) with a hammer and chisel, taking
care not to damage the cylinder head (3).
IMPORTANT
• Do not use seals once removed.
(16) Piston
RY9212001HYS0435US0
IMPORTANT
• Lightly tap out with a plastic hammer to avoid damaging
the piston rod (2) and cushion bearing (21).
3. Slide the cushion bearing (21) to the thread side of the piston
rod (2), and remove the stopper (24) (splits into two).
3-S145
IMPORTANT
• Apply hydraulic fluid beforehand to the cylinder head inner
surface.
Also check that there is no unevenness due to scratching,
etc., of the bushing after press fitting.
3-S146
IMPORTANT
• Make sure the buffer ring (21) and U-ring (5) are installed
with the correct orientation.
• Place the buffer ring (21) and U-ring (5) in hot water
(approx. 90 °C, 194 °F) for about five to ten minutes to
soften them prior to installation.
Seal assembly
1. Apply hydraulic fluid to the O-rings (7) (9) and backup ring (8)
and install in the cylinder head (3).
Piston assembly
1. Install the O-ring (17) for the seal ring assembly.
Apply hydraulic fluid to the O-ring (17).
3-S147
3. After installing the seal ring assembly, quickly pass through the
correcting tool (G) for correction.
(G) Tool
RY9212001HYS0452US0
4. To facilitate installation of the two slide rings (18), first roll them
tight (see photo) before installing.
IMPORTANT
• Take care so that the lip of the wiper ring and U-ring does
not catch on the stepped section.
(2) Piston rod (3) Cylinder head
RY9212032HYS0048US0
3-S148
IMPORTANT
• Take care over the installation orientation of the cushion
bearing (15).
IMPORTANT
• Tighten the piston to the specified torque.
(16) Piston
RY9212001HYS0461US0
3-S149
8. Hold the cylinder tube (1) horizontally in a vice, and insert the
piston rod (2) to which hydraulic fluid has been applied.
10. Firmly bend the lock washer into the cylinder head groove.
RY9212032HYS0052US0
3-S150
(24) Stopper
RY9212001HYS0459US0
IMPORTANT
• Lightly tap the rod and cushion bearing with a plastic
hammer.
(2) Piston rod (23) Snap ring
(21) Cushion bearing (24) Stopper
(22) Cushion seal
RY9212001HYS0460US0
3-S151
3-S152
3-S153
Right P/V
Used part Hose tape color
1 Bucket actuator White
2 Boom down Yellow
3 Bucket dump Red
4 Boom up Green
P Port P 44444444
T T Port 33333333
(a) Port P
(b) Port 3
(c) Port 2
(d) T Port
(e) Port 1
(f) Port 4
RY9212032HYS0055US0
3-S154
(2) Disassembly
Disassembly Procedures
CAUTION
• All of the parts are precisely made, so be very careful in handling them and taking care not to drop or hit
parts against each other.
• If you hit a part too hard while working on it, it may result in burrs or other damage, thus preventing
installation as well as oil leaks and/or compromised performance, so be careful when handling parts.
• If parts are left disassembled or left partway disassembled, humidity or foreign matter may cause rust, so
if interrupting the work is unavoidable, take precautions to protect the parts from rust and dust.
RY9212001HYS0476US0
1. Clamp the pilot valve in a vise.
IMPORTANT
• When clamping it in a vise, use a sheet of copper to prevent
scratching the pilot valve.
3-S155
4. After mounting tool (B) on the U-joint (15), use tool (A) to turn
the U-joint counterclockwise and loosen it.
CAUTION
• When removing the U-joint, take care that it does not pop
off.
3-S156
(2) Plate
RY9212001HYS0481US0
CAUTION
• Take care so the plug does not go flying.
• Take care not to damage it by exerting force unevenly.
• If a burr is formed, use a whetstone to remove it.
(3) Plug
RY9212001HYS0482US0
7. Remove the reducing valve ASSY (a) and the return spring (11).
IMPORTANT
• Tag the springs to positively ID which port they go to.
3-S157
IMPORTANT
• Be careful not to scratch the surface of the spool.
• Do not depress the spring seat 6 mm (0.2 in.) ≤
• Do not disassemble the reducing valve unless there is a
problem with it.
10. Remove the O-ring (6) and seal (5) from the plug (3).
IMPORTANT
• Use a mini slotted screwdriver.
• Be careful not to scratch the inside surface of the plug.
3-S158
(3) Assembly
Assembly Procedures
CAUTION
• Prepare your workbench in the same way as for disassembly.
• Follow the same general precautions as in the disassembly.
• When assembling the parts, remove all bits of metal or foreign matter from all the parts and make sure
there aren't any burrs or dings on the parts.
• Replace used O-rings with new ones.
• Take care not to damage the O-rings when installing them.
RY9212001HYS0001US0
1. Make sure there aren't any burrs or scratches inside the casing.
RY9212001HYS0487US0
IMPORTANT
• Install it in the same position as before disassembly.
(11) Spring
RY9212001HYS0488US0
3. Install the metal washer (8), spring (13) and spring seat (7) in
order to the spool (14).
IMPORTANT
• Do not depress the spring seat 6mm (0.2 in.) or more.
• Be careful not to scratch the spool.
IMPORTANT
• Install it in the same position as before disassembly.
RY9212001HYS0490US0
3-S159
IMPORTANT
• Be careful that the seal faces the right direction.
• Apply hydraulic oil on the circumference and lip of the seal.
IMPORTANT
• Apply hydraulic oil to the pushrod.
IMPORTANT
• Be careful not to scratch the hole of the casing by prying
on the spool.
• Take care so the plug ASSY does not go flying.
RY9212001HYS0494US0
3-S160
(2) Plate
RY9212001HYS0495US0
44 to 50 N·m
Tightening torque U-joint 4.5 to 5.1 kgf·m
32 to 37 lbf·ft
(A) Tool
RY9212001HYS0496US0
CAUTION
• If you tighten it too far, the mechanism will not function
properly when the lever is in neutral, so be careful to adjust
the nut to the correct position.
13. Apply grease to the rotating parts of the universal joint and to the
ends of the pushrods.
RY9212001HYS0499US0
3-S161
3-S162
3-S163
RY9212001HYS0503US0
3-S164
(17) Bushing
RY9212001HYS0504US0
CAUTION
• Note that there are two hex set screws per hole.
(13) Cam
RY9212001HYS0507US0
3-S165
(12) Cover
RY9212001HYS0509US0
IMPORTANT
• There is a shim on the edge of the pusher ASSY.
• If it comes off, return it to the top of the sleeve.
(25) O-Ring
RY9212001HYS0511US0
9. Mark the positioning of the body hole and the spool ASSY.
RY9212001HYS0512US0
10. Spool ASSY from the body (11) (a) Remove the spring (15).
3-S166
(1) Shim
RY9212001HYS0515US0
13. Clamp the spool in a vice and remove the hex socket bolt (21).
IMPORTANT
• Use a copper plate in the vice to prevent it from scratching
the spool.
• Be careful not to overtighten the vice as this will deform the
spool.
3-S167
(3) Seat
RY9212001HYS0519US0
(27) Ball
RY9212001HYS0520US0
(3) Seat
RY9212001HYS0522US0
14.7 N·m
Tightening torque Seat (3) 1.5 kgf·m
10.8 lbf·ft
• Tool to use : M5 hex socket
RY9212001HYS0523US0
3-S168
24.5 N·m
Tightening torque Flanged plug (20) 2.5 kgf·m
18.1 lbf·ft
• Tool to use : M6 hex socket
5. Clamp the spool (10) in a vice and install the flat metal washer
(24).
IMPORTANT
• Be careful to follow the order of installation.
• Use a copper plate in the vice to prevent it from scratching
the spool.
• Be careful not to overtighten the vice as this will deform the
spool.
IMPORTANT
• Be careful to follow the order of installation.
(8) Shim
RY9212001HYS0526US0
IMPORTANT
• Be careful to follow the order of installation.
(14) Spring
RY9212001HYS0527US0
IMPORTANT
• Be careful to follow the order of installation.
(4) Sleeve
RY9212001HYS0528US0
3-S169
IMPORTANT
• Be careful to follow the order of installation.
(16) Collar
RY9212001HYS0529US0
• Loctite #242
4.9 N·m
Tightening torque Hex socket bolt (21) 0.5 kgf·m
3.6 lbf·ft
• Tool to use : M3 hex socket
IMPORTANT
• Install the same number of shims as were disassembled.
3-S170
(15) Spring
RY9212001HYS0534US0
IMPORTANT
• Install in the same holes in the body as during
disassembly.
(28) O-Ring
RY9212001HYS0536US0
22.6 N·m
Tightening torque Cover (12) 2.3 kgf·m
16.7 lbf·ft
• Tool to use : M8 hex socket
3-S171
20. Apply grease to the sliding part of the pin and install it.
IMPORTANT
• Note that each one has two hex socket set screws (23).
9.8 N·m
Tightening torque Hex set screw (23) 1.0 kgf·m
7.2 lbf·ft
• Tool to use : M3 hex socket
(23) Hex set screw
RY9212001HYS0541US0
22. Install the boot (17).
(17) Bushing
RY9212001HYS0542US0
NOTE
• Use shims (1), (2), (8) or (9) as needed.
It is not a problem if there are no shims at all or a lot of
shims.
• Shims are used as needed, so be sure to install them where
there were used before.
RY9212001HYS0543US0
3-S172
3-S173
3-S174
3-S175
(1) Disassembly
1. Clamp the blade valve in a vise.
2. Remove the bellows (1) from the cover (20).
IMPORTANT
• Use a copper plate when clamping the part.
(1) Bellows (20) Cover
RY9212001HYS0551US0
IMPORTANT
• Note that Loctite was used so loosening will require a lot of
force.
4. Put a pin punch against the edge of the cam shaft (6) and tap it
lightly with a hammer to remove it.
IMPORTANT
• Handle the cam (4) and the ball (3) as an assembly.
(Cannot be disassembled)
• Mark the relationship between the cam (4) and the cover.
3-S176
CAUTION
• Mark the relationship between the cover (20) and the casing
(21).
• Be careful so the pushrod (16) and the plug (19) don't pop
out.
IMPORTANT
• Mark the relationship between the plug (19) and the casing
(21).
9. Remove the reducing valve ASSY A and the spring (7) from the
casing.
IMPORTANT
• Mark the relationship of the casing holes.
3-S177
IMPORTANT
• Be careful not to scratch the spool.
• Do not depress the spring seat 4 mm (0.2 in.) ≤
• Do not disassemble the reducing valve unless there is a
problem with it.
CAUTION
• Use a mini slotted screwdriver to remove it.
• Be careful not to scratch the inside surface of the plug.
3-S178
(2) Assembly
1. Install the metal washer, shim (15), secondary pressure setting
spring (8) and spring seat (10) in order to the spool (11).
IMPORTANT
• The thickness of the metal washers is different for each
spool ASSY due to the preset adjustment of the secondary
pressure setting spring (8).
IMPORTANT
• Be careful not to scratch the spool.
• Do not depress the spring seat 4 mm (0.2 in.) ≤
3. Clamp the casing (21) in a vise. Install the spring (7) in the
casing (21).
IMPORTANT
• Install it in the same position as before disassembly.
3-S179
IMPORTANT
• Install it in the same position as before disassembly.
• When installing the reducing valve ASSY, take care not to
hit the bottom edge of the spool hard against the corner B
or the casing.
IMPORTANT
• Apply hydraulic oil to the O-ring.
IMPORTANT
• Be careful that the gasket faces the right direction.
(The gasket (18) has an uneven shape ; put the end with a
larger diameter in first.)
• Apply hydraulic oil on the circumference and lip of the
gasket.
3-S180
IMPORTANT
• Apply hydraulic oil to the pushrod (16).
• Do not force the gasket (18) in as it may damage its lip.
9. Turn the cover on its side and tap lightly on the bushing (5) with
a hammer to install it.
IMPORTANT
• Take care not to knock the bushing so it sticks out from the
inside of the cover.
(5) Bushing
RY9212001HYS0573US0
10. Install the cover (20) on the casing (21).
IMPORTANT
• Install it in the same position as before disassembly.
• Note that the cover will ride up due to the springs.
IMPORTANT
• Install them so the cover sits flat.
8.8 N·m
Tightening torque Cover (20) 0.9 kgf·m
6.5 lbf·ft
• Tool to use : hex socket
RY9212001HYS0575US0
3-S181
IMPORTANT
• Install it in the same position as before disassembly.
IMPORTANT
• Grease the sliding part that holds the camshaft.
• Install the indentation in the cam faces up.
• Loctite #241
RY9212001HYS0578US0
IMPORTANT
• Use a soft spatula to apply the grease so you don't scratch
the surfaces of the pushrods or the plugs.
3-S182
IMPORTANT
• Before fitting the bottom edge of the bellows into the
groove of the cover, apply an anti-rust oil to the parts inside
the bellows.
3-S183
(a) 45 °
RY9212001HYS0583US0
3-S184
No. Name of part Q'ty Notes No. Name of part Q'ty Notes
(1) Plug 1 (12) Solenoid 2
(2) Plunger 1 (13) Screw adjustment 1
(3) Spring 1 (14) Flanged plug 2
(4) Spring 2 (15) Hex socket bolt 4
(5) Spool 2 (16) Hex socket bolt 2
(6) Plunger 1 (17) Hex nut 1
(7) Spring 1 (18) Rivet screw 2
(8) Nameplate 1 (19) O-Ring 2
(9) Cover 1 (20) O-Ring 1
(10) Plug 1 (21) O-Ring 4
(11) Body 1 (22) O-Ring 1
RY9212001HYS0584US0
3-S185
IMPORTANT
• Take care that the pushrods (23) do not fall out of the
solenoids (12).
3.92 N·m
Tightening torque Hex socket bolt (15) 0.4 kgf·m
2.89 lbf·ft
• Tool to use : M4 hex socket
(12) Solenoid (23) Pushrod
(15) Hex socket bolt
RY9212001HYS0586US0
2. Remove the O-rings (19).
IMPORTANT
• During assembly, install the O-rings (19) to the solenoids
(12) and then install them to the body (11).
• Apply grease to the O-rings.
(19) O-Ring
RY9212001HYS0587US0
26.5 N·m
Tightening torque Flanged plug (14) 2.7 kgf·m
19.5 lbf·ft
• Tool to use : M6 hex socket
IMPORTANT
• During assembly, apply hydraulic oil to the spool (5).
3-S186
5. Remove the hex nut (17) and the adjustment screw (13).
15.7 N·m
Tightening torque Hex nut (17) 1.6 kgf·m
11.6 lbf·ft
• Tool to use : M17 wrench
3.92 N·m
Tightening torque Hex socket bolt (16) 0.4 kgf·m
2.89 lbf·ft
• Tool to use : M4 hex socket
(10) Plug
RY9212001HYS0592US0
(21) O-Ring
RY9212001HYS0593US0
(7) Spring
RY9212001HYS0594US0
3-S187
IMPORTANT
• During assembly, apply hydraulic oil to the plunger (6).
(6) Plunger
RY9212001HYS0595US0
21.0 N·m
Tightening torque Plug (1) 2.1 kgf·m
15 lbf·ft
• Tool to use : M6 hex socket
(1) Plug
RY9212001HYS0596US0
12. Remove the spring (3).
(3) Spring
RY9212001HYS0597US0
IMPORTANT
• During assembly, apply hydraulic oil to the plunger (2).
(2) Plunger
RY9212001HYS0598US0
26.5 N·m
Tightening torque Flanged plug (14) 2.7 kgf·m
19.5 lbf·ft
• Tool to use : M6 hex socket
3-S188
(1) Body (5) O-ring (04810-00160) (9) Lever (a) A-C port oil passage lever
(2) Spool (6) O-ring (04810-00200) (10) Washer position
(3) Spring Pins (7) O-ring (04811-10200) (11) Spring Pins (b) A-B port oil passage lever
(4) O-ring (04811-10180) (8) O-ring (04612-50180) position
RY9212001HYS0609US0
3-S189
(1) Valve, ASSY (third line) (A) Service port, low-pressure (C) To boom base pipe (service A : U48-4
(2) Oil cooler side port port low pressure side) B : U55-4
(3) Control valve (U48-4) (B) Tank port
(4) Control valve (U55-4)
RY9212052HYS0041US0
3-S190
3-S191
3-S192
3-S193
RY9212052HYS0091US0
3-S194
3-S195
3-S196
3-S197
(1) Black (4) Red (7) Gray (AUX2 spec) (10) Green
(2) Yellow (5) White (8) Blue (11) Red (H/V spec)
(3) Green (6) Aqua blue (AUX2 spec) (9) Pink (12) Blue (H/V spec)
NOTE
• (a): AUX 1 Spec. Route the six hoses according to color of tape and clamp them with a plastic tie, then
put the two AUX1 hoses on top and clamp all eight hoses with a plastic tie.
• (b): AUX 2 Spec. Route the eight hoses according to color of tape and clamp them with a plastic tie, then
put the two AUX1 hoses on top and clamp all ten hoses with a plastic tie.
• (c): Gather the hoses with green tape (lift boom) and yellow tape (lower boom) and clamp with plastic tie.
• (d): Route the boom H/V hoses according to tape and clamp.
• (e): Wrap the cover from just after the colored tape and face the Velcro side up.
• (f): Install so the slit is at the bottom.
RY9212052HYS0047US0
3-S198
(a) Control valve (c) Swivel Joint (d) Cylinder, ASSY (swing) (e) 20 °
(b) Motor, ASSY (swivel)
RY9212052HYS0050US0
3-S199
(a) Control valve (c) Swivel Joint (d) Cylinder, ASSY (swing) (e) 20 °
(b) Motor, ASSY (swivel)
RY9212052HYS0051US0
3-S200
NOTE
• (a): Install the hose leaving room for at least one hose. (Travel left forward)
• (b): Install the hoses aiming at the stopper bolt. (lower blade, travel left BWD)
• (c): Install the travel hose (right fwd) so its hose band can be tightened from above.
• (d): Install parallel to the travel left fwd hose. (Travel right forward)
RY9212052HYS0093US0
3-S201
NOTE
• (A): When connecting the blade hose bracket and cylinder side hose, angle the connector down 10 °.
• (B): Connection of blade hose bracket and swivel side hose.
• (C): So hoses do not kink when blade moves up/down. (left/right same)
• (D): Hoses not to touch track frame (left/right same)
• (E): Hoses not to come in strong contact with track frame or each other.
• (F): Install tape on the swivel joint side.
• (G): Clamp the 2-speed signal hose with the high-pressure hose at this point. (right side only)
• (a): Install the left/right brackets so the welded nut comes forward.
• (b): Hoses to take a horizontal path. (align with the horizontal position of the welded nut, same right/left)
• (c): The corner of the right side bracket has a bevel to identify it.
RY9212052HYS0094US0
3-S202
RY9212052HYS0053US0
RY9212052HYS0054US0
3-S203
(a) Control valve assembly (d) Motor, ASSY (swivel) (f) Bracket (R, oil cooler) (h) Bracket (L, oil cooler)
(b) Hose (return, cooler) (e) Swivel Joint (g) Pipe (oil cooler)
(c) Pipe (return, cooler)
NOTE
• (A): Install so the hose will not kink.
Note) The number in parentheses that appears after the hose number is the protective tube number. Hose
No. (Protective tube no.)
RY9212052HYS0055US0
3-S204
(a) Control valve (d) Motor, ASSY (swivel) (f) Bracket (R, oil cooler) (h) Bracket (L, oil cooler)
(b) Hose (return, cooler) (e) Swivel joint (g) Pipe (oil cooler)
(c) Pipe (return, cooler)
NOTE
• (A): Install so the hose will not kink
Note) The number in parentheses that appears after the hose number is the (protective tube number). Hose
No. (Protective tube no.)
RY9212052HYS0056US0
3-S205
3-S206
3-S207
RY9212052HYS0057US0
3-S208
(a) Control valve (c) Coupler (Block PP) (e) Valve ASSY (unload) (g) Swivel joint, ASSY
(b) Pump assembly (piston) (d) Filter, assy (pressure) (f) Valve ASSY (proportional,
4)
RY9212052HYS0058US0
(a) Control valve (c) Coupler (Block PP) (e) Valve ASSY (unload) (g) Swivel joint, ASSY
(b) Pump assembly (piston) (d) Filter, assy (pressure) (f) Valve ASSY
(proportional, 4)
RY9212052HYS0059US0
3-S209
(a) Valve assembly (PV travel) (c) Pilot Valve (left) (f) Valve ASSY (PV, Blade) (g) Motor, ASSY (swivel)
(b) Valve, ASSY (PV swing) (d) Pilot Valve (right)
(e) Coupler (Block PP)
RY9212052HYS0060US0
(a) Valve assembly (PV travel) (b) Valve, ASSY (PV swing) (d) Pilot Valve (right) (A) U48-4
(c) Pilot Valve (left) (e) Valve assembly (PV, blade) (B) U55-4
RY9212052HYS0061US0
3-S210
(a) Control valve (b) Pilot Valve (left) (c) Pilot Valve (right)
RY9212052HYS0062US0
(a) Control valve (b) Pilot Valve (left) (c) Pilot Valve (right) (d) To boom holding valve
RY9212052HYS0063US0
3-S211
(8) Pilot Hose Routing (Travel, Blade, Swing, AUX1, AUX2) (U48-4)
(a) Control valve
(b) Valve assembly
(PV, blade)
(c) Valve ASSY
(proportional, 4)
(d) Valve, ASSY (PV swing)
(e) Valve assembly (PV travel)
RY9212052HYS0064US0
(9) Pilot Hose Routing (Travel, Blade, Swing, AUX1, AUX2) (U55-4)
(a) Control valve (c) Valve ASSY (d) Valve, ASSY (PV swing) (e) Valve assembly (PV travel)
(b) Valve assembly (PV, blade) (proportional, 4)
RY9212052HYS0065US0
3-S212
3-S213
NOTE
• (a): Route the 2-speed travel hoses inside the round pipe.
• (b): Clamp all the hoses.
• (c): Clamp the bundle of hoses to the guide bar of the battery box.
• (d): Clamp all the hoses. Align the brown tape and the guide of the battery box (rod) and install so the
delivery hoses do not touch it.
• (e): Route the pilot hoses so they hang on the guide (round rod) welded to the travel frame.
• (f): Route the bundle of pilot hoses so they hang on the guides (round rod).
• (g): To steering, dozer P/V
• (h): Clamp CV pilot hoses on the inside of the frame.
• (i): Gather the unload valve and CV pilot hoses together and clamp them.
• (j): Clamp CV pilot hoses on the outside of the frame.
• (k): Gather the boom H/V pilot hoses together where the hoses are taped and clamp them at the taped
position.
• (l): Route the boom H/V pilot hose inside the round rod.
RY9212052HYS0068US0
3-S214
(1) Clamp
NOTE
• (a): Clamp the travel 2-speed hose & the travel left FWD hose.
• (b): Aim for directly above PB3.
• (c): Hoses not to touch each other.
• (d): Aim for CV block mounting bolts.
• (e): To R/J 2-speed travel port
• (f): Pass the boom H/V Dr hose between the suction hose and the pilot valve (Right, T) hose.
• (g): Clamp. Aim for the white tape and the middle of the base of the hose.
• (h): Hang from the round rod
• (i): Install with a gap of at least 20mm (0.79 in.) from solenoid parts.
• (j): Install so hoses do not touch the boom lock (Dr) adapter or hoses.
• (k): Clamp the 2-speed travel and pilot base pressure hoses to the round rod welded to the return pipe.
• (l): Gather the boom lock Dr & 2-speed travel pilot base pressure hoses at the white tape and clamp them.
(AUX2 spec) Gather the AUX2 Low hose too and clamp together at the white tape.
• (m): Hang from the round rod welded to the return pipe.
• (n): To pilot valve for each operation
• (o): Clamp the bundle of hoses to the guide bar of the battery box.
• (p): Clamp all the pilot hoses that connect to control valves.
RY9212052HYS0069US0
3-S215
NOTE
• (a) To oil tank, P block (P, T hoses) To control valves (Hoses other than P, T).
• (b): Clamp.
• (c): Route the bundle of pilot hoses so they hang on the guides (round rod).
• (d): Boom Hose Routing.
RY9212052HYS0070US0
3-S216
RY9212001CVS0006US0
3-S217
IMPORTANT
• Since the purchase area of the box is minimal, take care so
that it does not come off.
3-S218
IMPORTANT
• Since the O-ring is difficult to remove by hand, use a punch
pin to punch out from the piston side.
• Tap lightly to avoid damaging the spool.
• Place an oil pan or other receptacle underneath to avoid
dropping the spool.
3-S219
IMPORTANT
• Apply hydraulic fluid to the spool.
55 to 65 N·m
Tightening torque Plug (10) 5.6 to 6.6 kgf·m
41 to 48 lbf·ft
• Tool to use: wrench (socket) 22 mm
RY9212001CVS0014US0
IMPORTANT
• Apply hydraulic fluid to the pistons.
34 to 39 N·m
Tightening torque Plug (15) 3.5 to 4.0 kgf·m
25 to 29 lbf·ft
• Tool to use: wrench (socket) 22 mm
RY9212001CVS0016US0
3-S220
IMPORTANT
• Since the purchase area of the box is minimal, take care so
that it does not come off.
29 to 39 N·m
Tightening torque (28) Relief valve 3.0 to 4.0 kgf·m
21 to 29 lbf·ft
• Tool to use: wrench (socket) M22
RY9212001CVS0017US0
7. Install the poppet (14) and spring (13).
IMPORTANT
• Apply hydraulic fluid to the spool.
39 to 49 N·m
Tightening torque Plug (11) 4.0 to 5.0 kgf·m
29 to 36 lbf·ft
• Tool to use: M8 hex socket
(11) Plug
RY9212001CVS0019US0
3-S221
Operating Procedures
1. Make sure the engine is stopped.
2. Remove the cover of the holding valve.
3. Loosen the nut (2) on the holding valve.
4. Tighten the needle valve (3) of the holding valve three turns.
5. Loosen the nut (4) and screw (5) of the shut-off valve on the
boom block.
CAUTION
• Do not loosen the shut-off valve screw quickly.
• Do not get under the boom.
3-S222
1. After operating, with the engine stopped, remove the hose at the
top of the pump from its clamp.
2. Insert a hexagonal plug, pinch the black plastic lock section, and
pull out the hexagonal plug.
3. Drape the hose on the front of the weight, and leave for
30 seconds.
4. Fit a hexagonal plug to the hose, start and idle the engine, and
check whether there is any cavitation noise from the pump.
5. Repeat operations in 2. 3. 4 until pump cavitation noise
subsides.
6. When cavitation noise subsides, raise the engine speed to
1500 rpm, slowly operated the arm and check whether
cavitation noise is emitted. (Make sure there is no relief when
operating the arm)
7. If there is no cavitation noise, raise the engine speed to
2000 rpm, slowly operate the arm, and check again for
cavitation noise. If cavitation noise is emitted, stop the engine
and carry out 2. 3.
8. If there is no cavitation noise in step 7, raise the engine speed
to maximum rpm, slowly operate the aim, and check again for
cavitation noise. If cavitation noise is emitted, stop the engine
and carry out 2. 3. (Make sure there is no relief when operating
the arm)
9. If there was no cavitation noise when performing step 8, air
bleeding is finished. Clamp the air bleed hose in its original
position.
(1) Air bleed hose (3) Lock section
(2) Hexagonal plug
RY9212001HYS0645US0
3-S223
3-S224
6. Place the machine's lock lever in the "Lock" position, and the
engine starter switch to the "STOP" position.
(1) Pump (3) Oil cooler (5) Joint (7) Oil catcher
(2) Control valve (4) Flow meter (6) Test hose (8) Pressure gauge
Measurement preparation
1. Place the mini excavator on flat, hard ground, lower the bucket and the blade, and stop the engine.
2. Follow the chapter "Releasing Hydraulic System Pressure" and release pressure in the hydraulic lines.
3. Use a vacuum pump and attach a pressure gauge to the pressure measurement port.
4. Disconnect the control valve side of the delivery hose and plug port P of the control valve.
5. Connect the delivery hose and the test hose and connect it to the IN side of the flow meter.
6. Disconnect the hose connecting the 2-way valve and the control valve (T2) on the control valve (T2) side and plug
the disconnected hose.
7. Connect the control valve (T2) and the OUT side of the flow meter with a test hose.
8. Disconnect the control valve side of the PPS hose and plug the control valve's PPS port.
9. Place the PPS hose in an oil catcher.
10. Remove the vacuum pump.
11. Bleed the pump of air and make sure there are no oil leaks in any of the pipes.
RY9212052HYS0095US0
3-S225
3-S226
(1) Pump (3) Oil cooler (5) Joint (7) Oil catcher
(2) Control valve (4) Flow meter (6) Test hose (8) Pressure gauge
Measurement preparation
1. Place the mini excavator on flat, hard ground, lower the bucket and the blade, and stop the engine.
2. Follow the chapter "Releasing Hydraulic System Pressure" and release pressure in the hydraulic lines.
3. Use a vacuum pump and attach a pressure gauge to the pressure measurement port.
If measuring P3 flow
1. Disconnect the control valve side of the P3 delivery hose and plug port P3 of the control valve.
2. Connect the P3 delivery hose and the test hose and connect it to the IN side of the flow meter.
3. Disconnect the hose connecting the 2-way valve and the control valve (T2) on the control valve (T2) side and plug
the disconnected hose.
4. Connect the control valve (T2) and the OUT side of the flow meter with a test hose.
5. Disconnect the control valve side of the PPS hose and plug the control valve's PPS port.
6. Place the PPS hose in an oil catcher.
7. Remove the vacuum pump.
8. Bleed the pump of air and make sure there are no oil leaks in any of the pipes.
RY9212052HYS0096US0
3-S227
3-S228
3-S229
(1) T1
(2) AUX1 (low-pressure side)
(3) AUX1 (high-pressure side)
(4) Swivel right
(5) Swivel left
(6) Bucket, bottom
(7) Bucket, rod
(8) Arm, bottom
(9) Arm, rod
(10) Boom, bottom
(11) Boom, rod
(12) Travel right forward
(13) Travel right rear
(14) Travel left forward
(15) Travel left rear
(16) Swing, bottom
(17) Swing, rod
(18) Blade, rod
(19) Blade, bottom
(20) AUX2 (low-pressure side)
(21) AUX2 (high-pressure side)
(22) Inlet (P1)
(23) T3
(24) Independent travel valve (P1)
(25) Independent travel valve (P2)
(26) Communication valve (P3)
(27) T2
(28) PPS
(29) PLS
(A) U48-4
(B) U55-4
(a) Main Travel Right relief valve
(b) Main Travel Left relief valve
(c) Main P3 relief valve
(d) Main LS relief valve
RY9212052HYS0075US0
3-S230
CAUTION
• There is deviation between machines on account of the n=10 measurement being entered.
RY9212052HYS0098US0
3-S231
CAUTION
• Deviation between machines occurs because of the n = 10 measurement being entered.
RY9212052HYS0100US0
3-S232
(A) U48-4
(B) U55-4
(a) Main Travel Right relief valve
(b) Main Travel Left relief valve
(c) Main P3 relief valve
(d) Main LS relief valve
RY9212052HYS0078US0
3-S233
Measurement preparation
1. Place the mini excavator on flat, hard ground, lower the bucket and the blade, and stop the engine.
2. Follow the chapter "Releasing Hydraulic System Pressure" and release pressure in the hydraulic lines.
3. Using a vacuum pump, disconnect the high-pressure hose on the valve section port attached to the overload relief
valve to be measured and plug the removed hose.
• When measuring the boom holding valve
Remove the hose from port A and connect the test hose to port A.
Disconnect the hose on the boom rod side and block it with a plug.
4. Connect to the free port with a pipe joint, test hose and injection pressure gauge.
5. Remove the vacuum pump.
CAUTION
• Use a test hose that is rated to at least the pressure setting to be tested.
• Take care not to misconnect or twist the hose.
• When disconnecting the hose after testing the pressure, loosen the pipe joint (4) and the injection
pressure gauge slightly and make sure the pressure bleeds off before disconnecting them.
• When testing the boom holding function, the boom may rise due to air getting into the lines. If the boom
does rise, after finishing testing, follow the section Guide to Releasing the Boom Holding Valve and lower
the boom.
RY9212032HYS0095US0
3-S234
CAUTION
• There is deviation between machines on account of the n=1 measurement being entered.
RY9212052HYS0117US0
Jig for Measuring
(1) Support
A 100 mm, 3.94 in.
B 50 mm, 2.0 in.
C t = 2.3 mm, 0.09 in.
D 70 mm, 2.8 in.
E 15 mm, 0.59 in.
F 600 mm, 23.6 in.
G 2-11 mm, 2-0.43 in.
Material grade: STKR400
RY9212032HYS0097US0
3-S235
3-S236
3-S237
NOTE
• When measuring at the relief valve pressure inspection
port side of the swivel motor, the pressure rises by about
10 % of the relief valve pressure setting. For more accurate
measurement, attach the pressure gauge to the discharge
port side of the swivel motor.
(1) Pump 1 pressure check port plug (2) Swivel right relief valve
(3) Swivel left relief valve
RY9212052HYS0105US0
Swivel Relief Valve Pressure (U55-4)
1. Place the mini excavator on flat hard ground, lower the bucket
and the blade, and stop the engine.
2. In accordance with "Releasing Residual Hydraulic System
Pressure" in this manual, release pressure from the hydraulic
line.
3. Remove the plug (1) from the adapter's inspection port on the
discharge side of the pump to be measured, and attach a
pressure gauge.
4. Start and idle the engine, and check that there is no oil leakage.
5. Place the bucket against something robust, lock the machine so
that it does not move, slowly operate the swivel lever from left to
right and from right to left, and take the relief pressure reading
at maximum engine speed.
Perform the measurement 3 times; take the average and use
this as the measurement value.
Conduct at oil temperature 50 ± 5 °C (122 ± 9 °F).
NOTE
• When measuring at the relief valve pressure inspection
port side of the swivel motor, the pressure rises by about
10 % of the relief valve pressure setting. For more accurate
measurement, attach the pressure gauge to the discharge
port side of the swivel motor.
(1) Pump 1 pressure check port plug (4) Swivel right relief valve
(2) Pump 2 pressure check port plug (5) Swivel left relief valve
(3) Pump 3 pressure check port plug
RY9212052HYS0107US0
3-S238
CAUTION
• Before commencing measurement, make sure there are no
persons or obstacles within the swivel range.
(a) 1 m, 40 in.
RY9212052HYS0110US0
3-S239
CAUTION
• Place safety blocks and supports under the jacked up
machine to prevent it from dropping.
8. Rotate the crawler on the measuring side for one minute with
the engine at maximum rpm, collect hydraulic fluid from the
measuring use hose in a receptacle, and take the
measurement. Take the measurement from right to left and left
to right two to three times, and determine the average value.
CAUTION
• For safety's sake, keep hands and feet out from under the
crawler.
RY9212052HYS0111US0
Swivel Block Performance
1. Before measuring, repeat swivel left and right operations to
sufficiently warm up the swivel motor. Set the hydraulic fluid
temperature to 50 ± 5 °C (122 ± 9 °F).
2. Place dirt or a weight of the specified weight (JIS heap x specific
gravity 1.8) in the bucket.
[U48-4 : 252 kg (556 lbs), U55-4 : 288 kg (635 lbs)]
3. The ground slope for measuring should be 20° and the machine
set on the slope with the front perpendicular to the sloping
surface.
4. The front attitude should be with the arm cylinder fully
compressed and bucket cylinder fully extended, holding the
boom on a straight line between the boom base pin and bucket
pin.
5. Place markers on the circumference of the swivel bearing and
track frame.
6. Start the engine, release the safety lock lever at idling rpm (lever
down), and measure the slippage over one minute.
7. Take the measurement from right to left and left to right two to
three times, and determine the average value.
CAUTION
• Before commencing measurement, make sure there are no
persons or obstacles within the swivel range.
RY9212052HYS0082US0
3-S240
3-S241
CAUTION
• Before commencing measurement, make sure there are no
persons or obstacles within the swivel range.
RY9212001HYS0673US0
3-S242
(a) Run-up (5 m, 200 in.) (b) Measuring area (10 m, 390 in.)
RY9212001HYS0674US0
Amount of travel drift
1. Before measuring, adjust the left and right crawlers to even
tension, and operate the travel motor to thoroughly warm it up.
Set the hydraulic fluid temperature to 50 ± 5 °C (122 ± 9 °F).
2. Determine a 10 m travel course on firm, flat ground, and set the
measuring attitude to travel attitude.
3. At maximum engine rpm, travel for 10 m (390 in.), and measure
the amount of drift (a).
4. Perform the measurement three times, backwards and
forwards; determine the average value, and take this as the
measured value.
Lever stroke
1. Stop the engine.
2. Move each control lever (travel, arm, bucket, blade and swivel)
from neutral to stroke end, and measure at the top center of the
grip.
3. If there is backlash in neutral, take two measurements.
4. Measurement is by linear dimensions.
5. Perform the measurement three times, determine the average
value, and take this as the measured value.
RY9212001HYS0677US0
3-S243
15. TROUBLESHOOTING
Front System Troubleshooting
All front operations slow or not moving
Reference
Cause Inspection point Remedy
page
Defect of the engine itself Engine speed measurement Adjust each engine part
Insufficient hydraulic fluid volume Check hydraulic tank oil level Replenish the hydraulic fluid
or oil degradation and oil quality supply or change the oil
Suction line (suction filter) Inspect the suction line Wash the suction line
blockage (suction filter) Replace the suction line
Pilot filter blockage Pilot filter blockage inspection Replace pilot filter
Adjust, wash or replace pilot
Pilot relief valve faulty operation or Pilot primary pressure
relief valve
poor pilot pump performance measurement
Replace pilot pump
Poor main relief valve operation or Main relief valve pressure Adjust, wash or replace main
seating measurement relief valve
Poor unload valve operation or Control valve unload Wash unload valve seat
seating pressure measurement surface or replace
Drop in control differential pressure Pump LS regulator spool Wash LS regulator spool
due to LS regulator spool stick inspection Replace LS regulator spool
Defective pump installation Pump installation coupling
Replace pump coupling
coupling inspection
Pump drive shaft breakage Pump drive shaft inspection Replace shaft
Pump internal parts wear or
Pump inspection Repair or replace pump
damage
Either pilot valve right or left front does not move or is slow
Reference
Cause Inspection point Remedy
page
Pilot valve line filter blockage
Pilot valve line filter blockage Clean pilot filter line filter
inspection
Pilot secondary pressure
Pilot valve disassembly,
Defective pilot valve measurement of applicable
cleaning or replacement
cylinder
3-S244
3-S245
3-S246
Swivel drift
Reference
Cause Inspection point Remedy
page
Check that the pilot valve Pilot valve disassembly,
Pilot valve spool stick
spool has returned to neutral cleaning or replacement?
Control valve swivel section Control valve spool
Swivel section spool stick
spool inspection disassembly and washing
Defective swivel relief specified Swivel relief pressure Swivel relief valve washing or
pressure measurement replacement
Swivel motor make-up poppet stick Swivel motor make-up poppet Make-up poppet disassembly
or defective seat surface inspection and washing
Swivel motor drain volume Swivel motor disassembly,
Internal defect of swivel motor
measurement replacement
RY9212032HYS0074US0
3-S247
CONTENTS
RY9212052ELS0001US0
4-S1
2. WIRING CIRCUIT
[1] PRECAUTIONS ON HOW TO CLAMP THE ELECTRICAL WIRING
1. Do not touch the wiring or the area around it.
Do not touch where uncovered.
2. Do not clamp to fuel hoses.
3. Connect connectors and terminals securely so they do not come unplugged when pulled on gently.
4. Be sure to clamp the harness at the clamp position.
4-S2
4-S3
4-S4
4-S5
4-S6
4-S7
4-S8
4-S9
4-S10
(When connecting)
• Press the connector all the way in, close the lever and make
sure it is securely locked.
(a) Lever (c) Release
(b) Lock button (d) Lock
RY9212001ELS0267US0
4-S11
RY9212032ELS0060US0
4-S12
4-S13
4-S14
4. INSPECTIONS
[1] POWER AND GROUND
Slow-blow fuses
IMPORTANT
• When replacing a slow-blow fuse, always use the same
capacity fuse and replace it after determining why it blew.
(1) Slow-blow fuses
RY9212001ELS0027US0
Fuses
IMPORTANT
• When replacing a fuse, always use the same capacity fuse
and replace it after determining why it blew.
(1) Fuse box
RY9212001ELS0029US0
Inspecting fuses
• Measurement parameter: check continuity across its terminals
RY9212001ELS0031US0
4-S15
4-S16
Battery
Check the voltage between the terminals
1. Connect a circuit tester between the (+) and (-) terminals of the
battery and measure the voltage across the terminals.
2. If the measurement is below factory specs, check the specific
gravity of the electrolyte.
Voltage between
Factory Spec At least DC 12V
terminals
4-S17
4-S18
Starter relay
Harness-side voltage
1. Turn the key switch OFF and remove the starter relay.
2. Turn the key switch to RUN and measure the voltage between
connector terminal 3 on the fuse box side and the body.
3. If the measurement meets factory specs, it is OK.
Measured voltage Factory Spec 11 to 14 V (battery voltage)
RY9212001ELS0038US0
Glow relay
Harness-side voltage
1. Turn the key switch OFF and remove the glow relay.
2. Turn the key switch to OFF and measure the voltage between
connector terminal 3 on the fuse box side and the body.
3. If the measurement meets factory specs, it is OK.
Measured voltage Factory Spec 11 to 14V (battery voltage)
4. Turn the key switch to RUN and measure the voltage between
connector terminal 1 on the fuse box side and the body.
5. If the measurement meets factory specs, it is OK.
Measured voltage Factory Spec 11 to 14 V (battery voltage)
RY9212001ELS0040US0
Glow relay test
1. Turn the key switch OFF and remove the glow relay.
2. Measure the resistance between terminals 1 and 4.
3. Check for continuity between terminals 2 and 3.
Measured items (+) (–) Factory Spec
Coil Terminal 1 Terminal 4 72 to 88 Ω
Contact Terminal 2 Terminal 3 No continuity
4-S19
4-S20
Switch (limit)
1. Remove the 2P connector of the limit switch.
2. Move the equipment lock lever up and down and check for
continuity between the connector terminals when the limit
switch is pressed and when it is free.
Key switch circuit table
4-S21
(1) User setting switch (Switch 1). (8) Hour meter - Engine tachometer
(2) Overload warning switch (Switch 2). (9) Fuel gauge
(3) AUX port enable switch (Switch 3). (10) Warning lamp (red, yellow)
(4) Information switch (Switch 4). (11) Oil lamp
(5) Display selector switch (Switch 5). (12) Charge lamp
(6) Clock display (13) Speed indicator light
(7) Water temperature gauge
RY9212007ELS0001US0
Display at menu-selection
(1) Direction cursor switch (Switch 1) (4) Cursor move switch (Switch 4)
Stop each setting and return to the (5) Save switch (Switch 5)
original screen. Decision of the selection item.
(2) Cursor move switches (Switch 2) Selecting the item at the
Move down the selection item. menu-selection position.
Move down the menu-selection
position.
(3) Cursor move switches (Switch 3)
Move up the selection item.
Move up the menu-selection
position.
RY9212007ELS0002US0
RY9212007ELS0003US0
4-S22
RY9212007ELS0004US0
RY9212007ELS0005US0
4-S23
In the case of display of the periodical check notices on the meter console.
4-S24
IMPORTANT
• The periodic check can be preset to be made disappear
automatically after the key switch is turned ON and Off 10
times or more.
(this is standard for non-EU version)
• The periodic check screen can be preset to be made
disappear manually only.
(this is standard for EU version)
To make this setting, please contact your local dealer.
• When the periodical check interval has passed, the
massage "Periodic Check Passed" is displayed.
RY9212007ELS0006US0
RY9212007ELS0007US0
4-S25
(1) Cursor move switch (2) Item move switch (Switch 5) (A) Date/Month/Year display (B) Clock display
(Switch 2 and 3)
1. Using the cursor move switchs (SW2 and 3), move up and down the times.
The date / month / year on side (A) will be recorded.
2. Using the item move switch (SW4), move the cursor to side (B). Select the "AM / PM" system or the "24-hour"
system.
3. Press the save switch (SW5), and the new settings will be made.
If the direction cursor switch (SW1) is pressed, the previous settings will remain.
RY9212007ELS0008US0
4-S26
4-S27
[Operation 2]
Feed the fuel. The beeping interval varies in response to the
quantity of the fuel in the tank.
When reaching near the fill-up condition, the beeping sound will
become near the continuous sound. Therefore, confirm the
conditions until the fill-up by hearing the beeping sounds during
fueling.
When the fueling need to be stopped halfway (before full fill-up),
beeping can be stopped by pressing the fill-up announcing buzzer
or by leaving the system as it is for a moment (10 minutes).
RY9212007ELS0011US0
4-S28
[Mode 1]
AUX 1 port : Max. flow volume
[Mode 2]
AUX 1 port : Limited flow volume
[Mode 3]
AUX 1 port : One way flow (Send oil to the port 2 only)
4-S29
[Mode 1]
AUX 1 port : MAX. flow volume
AUX 2 port : MAX. flow volume
[Mode 2]
AUX 1 port : One way flow (Send oil to the port 2 only)
AUX 2 port : MAX. flow volume
NOTE
• When turning the starter key to the "RUN" position, the action mode will return to the last action mode
used.
RY9212032ELS0065US0
Checking the settings of each action mode
When an action mode is selected and the Information mark (2)
appears at the lower right of the icon, the flow volume setting gets
displayed by pressing the switch 4.
4-S30
NOTE
• If the pilot control lock lever is not at the "UNLOCK"
position, the following message appears on the screen.
Down this lever to the "UNLOCK" position first and then
press the AUX port enable switch (switch 3).
4-S31
NOTE
• Even if the one way hold switch of the left attachment
control lever is pressed, no function is assigned.
In this case, the following message appears on the screen.
2. Press the switch 2 or 3 to select "AUX Flow Ctr Set", and then
press the save switch (switch 5).
(1) Cursor move switch (switch 2 and 3) (2) Save switch (switch 5)
RY9212032ELS0075US0
4-S32
NOTE
• There is no relationship between the icons and the flow
control settings. Select icons to suit the images of
attachments to be connected.
• In an action mode with the disable icon preset, such action
mode is skipped even if selected.
Each time the AUX port enable switch (switch 3) is pressed, the
display changes from action mode 1, action mode 2 to normal mode
in this order.
(a) AUX (Standard) (f) Clamshell
(b) Brush cutter (g) Breaker
(c) Rotary grapple (h) Tilt bucket
(d) Grapple (i) Blank (disable)
(e) Auger
RY9212032ELS0079US0
4-S33
6. Set the maximum flow volume for each AUX port. Press the
switch 4 to move the setting cursor (arrow mark) to the port 2
position of AUX1 at the right.
4-S34
NOTE
• Some attachments might not be activated even when the
bar level is still somewhat above the lowest position. Or
even when the bars of ports 1 and 2 (or of ports 3 and 4) are
at the same level, the same speed might not be achieved.
Those cases are not a machine failure, however. Readjust
the bar to the optimum level according to your
attachments.
• Suppose that the same attachment is mounted on another
machine. Even if the flow control setting is made, the same
speed cannot be achieved. Make an optimum setting on
each machine.
(1) Switch 2 (Lower flow volume) (A) "MAX. flow volume"
(2) Switch 3 (Higher flow volume) (B) "Output interrupted"
RY9212032ELS0083US0
8. Go back to Step 3 to make settings for the next action mode.
When all the settings of all the action modes have been made,
press the switch 1 to return to the normal screen.
IMPORTANT
• When the AUX port is not used for a long period, dirt
particles can settle in the lower part of the AUX port lines.
When the plugs on the AUX port lines are removed to
connect attachments, drain approx. 100 cc (3.4 oz) of oil
before making connections.
(1) Switch 1
RY9212052ELS0003US0
4-S35
RY9212032ELS0085US0
4-S36
RY9212007ELS0012US0
4-S37
(1) Diagnosis
[A] Tester
Using the tester mode, check to see the conditions of the various sensors and the information of switches.
RY9212007ELS0013US0
[Image 1]
Contents Instruction, Set Value
During engine stop : 0 rpm
Engine RPM
During engine rotation : 1050 rpm
Voltage (Battery) Battery voltage : ±0.5 V
Before engine Start : ON
Oil
After engine Start : OFF
Before engine Start : ON
Charge
After engine Start : OFF
The key at the START position : ON
Starter
The key at other positions : OFF
RY9212007ELS0014US0
4-S38
* Fuel caution
RY9212007ELS0015US0
[Image 3]
Contents Instruction, Set Value
Travel 2 speed SW Press the switch : ON
Travel 2 speed SOL Solenoid : ON/OFF
Lever Lock SW Press the switch : ON
Lever lock SOL Solenoid : ON/OFF
Air Cleaner Electric sensor is not installed.
RY9212007ELS0016US0
[Image 4]
Contents Instruction, Set Value
Actual value : (0.25 to 4.75 V)
Accelerator POT
Designed value : ldling (Lower), MAX (Higher)
Actual value : (0.25 to 4.75 V)
Governor POT
Designed value : ldling (Lower), MAX (Higher)
During AI motor operation : 0.0 to 15.0 A
Motor Current
During AI motor stop : 0.0 to 2.0 A
RY9212007ELS0017US0
4-S39
RY9212007ELS0020US0
[Image 10]
Contents Instruction, Set Value
Antenna normal : P
Antenna for anti-theft
Antenna abnormal : ×
Present-absent, Key present : P, Anti-theft mode : P
valid-invalid Key absent : ×, Anti-theft canceled : ×
Identified as the red key : P, identified as the black
key : P
Red key, black key
Not identified as the red key: ×, not identified as the
black key : ×
Identified as the yellow key : P, identified as the
green key : P
Yellow key, green key
Not identified as the yellow key : ×, not identified as
the green key : ×
• Yellow key and Green key are equipped with North American
Versions.
RY9212007ELS0021US0
4-S40
RY9212007ELS0022US0
[Image 13]
Contents Instruction, Set Value
At the normal condition : P
Meter
(P when the meter exists.)
At the normal condition : P
ECU (Main)
(P when the ECU (Main) exists.)
RY9212007ELS0023US0
[Image 14]
Contents Instruction, Set Value
Ver Version of the program
Rev Program preparation date (Year, month, day)
Serial number Serial number (Different number for each machine.)
RY9212007ELS0024US0
[Image 15]
Contents Instruction, Set Value
Ver Version of the program
Rev Program preparation date (Year, month, day)
Serial number Serial number (Different number for each machine.)
RY9212007ELS0025US0
4-S41
CAUTION
• Indication does not disappear even if you turn off the key in
the tester mode.
When it is completed, press sw1, and get out of tester
mode.
(When you turn off the key and leave if as tester mode,
indication disappears three minutes later.)
RY9212007ELS0027US0
(1) The ECU that detected the failure is indicated. (Main) (Meter)
(2) Number of occurrences (1-255 times)
(3) The first date of occurrence (Date/Month/Year) and hour meter.
The last date of occurrence (Date/Month/Year) and hour meter.
RY9212007ELS0028US0
4-S42
RY9212007ELS0029US0
4-S43
(2)
[A] AI Setting
Setting procedures that are necessary when the AI motor, AI motor cable, or governor sensor have been
adjusted.
RY9212007ELS0030US0
4-S44
RY9212007ELS0031US0
4-S45
4-S46
RY9212007ELS0032US0
4-S47
4-S48
RY9212007ELS0033US0
4-S49
4-S50
RY9212007ELS0034US0
4-S51
RY9212007ELS0035US0
4-S52
[G] AUX2 Setting the pressure rise (proportional valve or spool changed)
If AUX2 proportional valve or spool has been replaced ; set up the pressure rise of pressure header.
4-S53
RY9212007ELS0036US0
4-S54
4-S55
RY9212007ELS0037US0
4-S56
RY9212007ELS0038US0
4-S57
Pre-set code
Model Arm Length (A) Type of Track
number
Iron track 4840
1820 mm
(71.65 in.) Rubber track or Wide
0744
KX057-4 iron track
1570 mm
Rubber track 0744
(61.81 in.)
Iron track 7253
1570 mm
U55-4 Rubber track 7281
(61.81 in.)
Wide iron track 3189
RY9212032ELS0089US0
[Testing Method]
1. Weight of suspended weight: 500 ~ 600 kg (1110 ~ 1320 lbs)
(No bucket, includes weight of rigging)
2. No-load height (A): Approx. 1300 mm (51.18 in.)
(Height from bottom of weight to rigging point)
3. Hoisting Posture
a) Max digging radius posture
The arm cylinder fully compressed, the excavator facing
forward, dozer lowered and in a central swing position.
b) Vertical arm posture
The arm vertical, the excavator facing forward, dozer
lowered and in a central swing position.
4. Test procedure (lifting the weight off the ground)
• Press the overload warning button on the instrument panel
and put the excavator in the a) Max digging radius posture.
• With the engine idling, slow raise the boom.
• Lift the weight to a height of approx. 300 mm (11.8 in.) and
if the warning sounds, it is operating normally.
• Put the excavator in the b) Arm vertical posture, and lift the
weight slowly with the engine idling.
• Lift the weight to a height of approx. 300 mm (11.8 in.) and
if the warning does not sound, it is operating normally.
[Evaluation Standard]
Hoisting Posture Criteria
a) Max digging radius posture Warning sounds (OK)
b) Vertical arm posture Warning does not sound (OK)
(To be continued)
4-S59
RY9212007ELS0039US0
4-S60
[K] Others
1. AI motor drive
Setting procedures when AI motor lever position is to be moved.
RY9212007ELS0040US0
4-S61
4-S62
RY9212007ELS0042US0
4-S63
RY9212007ELS0043US0
4-S64
RY9212007ELS0044US0
4-S65
[L] Operate in AUX2 with a AUX1 knob (Or operate in AUX1 with an AUX2 knob)
RY9212007ELS0045US0
4-S66
RY9212007ELS0046US0
4-S67
1. In the case of confirming whether or not the temporary replacement by the meters and ECU's of the other
machine will make the machine operable.
RY9212007ELS0047US0
4-S68
RY9212007ELS0048US0
4-S69
This key is used to start the engine. It is possible to start the engine
as before by inserting the key and turning it to the [START] position.
Registering a bIack key with the machine by using the red key will
Back key allow the black key to start the engine. A key not registered with the
(individual key) machine cannot be used to start the engine.
* Initially two keys including a spare key are supplied. The two
accompanying keys have been already registered. Up to four keys
can be registered.
If a black key for starting the engine should be lost, the red key is
used to register another black key with the machine.
Red key
The engine cannot be started with this key.
(registration key)
For the method of using the red key, refer to "How to register a black
key with the machine".
RY9212007ELS0050US0
How to register a black key (individual key) with the machine (When a black key is lost)
WARNING
• To avoid personal injury or death :
– Before programming an anti-theft key, be sure to sit on the operator's seat and make sure all the
control levers are in the "Neutral" position. If this is neglected, the machine may get moving as soon
as the engine gets started, leading to a dangerous situation.
– The exhaust gas from the engine includes harmful substances such as carbon monoxide. Be careful
not to make this setting in a room where the exhaust gases easily build up or in an ill-ventilated place.
RY9212007ELS0051US0
4-S70
4-S71
NOTE
• If a registered black key is stolen or lost, re-register the remaining black key. When re-registering is
performed, the stolen or lost black key is unregistered and it becomes impossible to start the engine with
that key.
• If the red key is stolen or lost, it becomes impossible to register or re-register a black key (for starting the
engine) and the peripheral devices should be replaced. Therefore keep the red key with great care. If by
any chance it gets lost, promptly contact your dealer or a KUBOTA-designated service factory.
• Use the KUBOTA-specified key ring to hold the black key or the red key. Any unspecified key rings may
interfere with the signal transfer between the key and the key switch, possibly failing to start the engine
or to register a key properly.
• Do not bundle two or more keys when using them. Doing so may cause electric wave interference,
possibly failing to start the engine.
• Cut and remove the ring that is used to bundle the keys at the time of delivery. (If the keys are used still
bundled, the engine may get started with the red key or re-registering could not be performed properly.)
• If an unregistered key is inserted and turned more than six times, the alarm sounds for 30 seconds.
(The alarm keeps sounding even if the key is drawn out.)
• * Insert and turn on the registered key, and the alarm stops itself.
• If something is wrong with the machine, immediately contact your dealer and have the machine inspected
and repaired.
RY9212007ELS0053US0
For U.S.A. and Canada (FCC/IC)
FCC WARNING
• Changes or modifications not expressly approved by the party responsible for compliance could void the user's
authority to operate the equipment.
• This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC Rules and RSS-Gen of the lC rules.
Operation is subject to the following two conditions : (1) this device may not cause harmful interference, and (2)
this device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired operation.
RY9212007ELS0054US0
RY9212007ELS0055US0
4-S72
Tilt up the pilot control lock lever. Tilt up the pilot control lock lever.
This message indicates a
2 This message disappears by tilting This message disappears by tilting
procedural step.
up the pilot control lock lever. up the pilot control lock lever.
Tilt down the pilot control lock Tilt down the pilot control lock
This message indicates a lever. lever.
3
procedural step. This message disappears by tilting This message disappears by tilting
down the pilot control lock lever. down the pilot control lock lever.
4-S73
Charging system is in trouble. The machine works until the Immediately contact your local
16
Charging is failure. battery gets dead. dealer.
4-S74
The engine can run, but the Immediately contact your local
22 The lock lever system is in trouble.
machine fails to move. dealer.
4-S75
The engine has been started with Start the engine with the correct
37 The engine fails to start.
the red key (registration key) key.
For jobs (excavating, for example) For jobs (excavating, for example)
other than lifting, press the other than lifting, press the
overload warning switch and overload warning switch and
39 The load being lifted is too heavy. release the warning. release the warning.
The load being lifted is too heavy. The load being lifted is too heavy.
Place it on the ground to lessen Place it on the ground to lessen
the lifting load. the lifting load.
RY9212007ELS0056US0
4-S76
[Test Conditions]
1. Key switch : ON
4-S77
Assessment
Criteria
Results
Regular : no break (OK)
Irregular : has a break (NG)
Irregular : shorted (NG)
4-S78
Regular : 5V (OK)
Irregular : Large discrepancy from 5V (NG)
RY9212001ELS0057US0
2. Continuity check
[Measurement Conditions]
1. Key switch : OFF
2. Disconnect meter connector CN2.
3. Test the continuity based on the table below.
Connector
Mea- Connector Assess-
Name Pin
sure- Name Pin No. ment
(+ terminal No.
ment (- terminal side) Results
side)
Oil switch Meter connector
(a) <1> <9>
connector CN28 CN2
15 to 19 N-m
Oil switch tapering screw
Torque 1.5 to 2.0 kgf·m
R1/8
11 to 14 lbf·ft
Assessment
Criteria
Results
Regular : Within factory spec (OK)
Irregular : Outside factory spec (NG)
RY9212001ELS0059US0
2. Settings after replacing device
1. No settings required.
RY9212001ELS0013US0
4-S79
[Test Conditions]
1. Key switch : ON
4-S80
Assessment
Criteria
Results
Regular : no break (OK)
Irregular : has a break (NG)
Irregular : shorted (NG)
2. Checking relays
1. Checking relays is not necessary.
RY9212001ELS0009US0
3. Causes when a break in wiring
[Test Conditions]
1. Key switch : OFF
2. The alternator connector CN25 is disconnected.
3. There is a break somewhere in the wiring.
4-S81
Regular : 12 V (OK)
Irregular : Large discrepancy from 12 V (NG)
RY9212001ELS0066US0
2. Continuity check
[Measurement Conditions]
1. Key switch : OFF
2. Disconnect meter connector CN2.
3. Remove the 10A fuse.
4. Test the continuity based on the table below.
Connector
Mea- Connector Assess-
Name Pin
sure- Name Pin No. ment
(+ terminal No.
ment (- terminal side) Results
side)
Alternator Meter connector
(a) <2> <10>
connector CN25 CN2
Meter connector
(b) <1> 10A fuse –
CN2
4-S82
(A) Displacement 7 to 9 mm
(0.3 to 0.4 in.)
RY9212001ELS0068US0
2. Settings after replacing device
1. No settings required.
RY9212001ELS0013US0
3. Erasing failure history
1. After completing repairs, select Erase Failure History and erase
the records.
2. After erasing the records, read the failure history again and
make sure there are no failures.
Assessment
Criteria
Results
Regular : Failure history erased (OK)
Irregular : failure history not erased
(NG)
4-S83
3. Tester mode
1. Select the tester mode.
2. Start the engine.
3. Check the display for the voltage and resistance of the fuel
based on the following table.
Fuel voltage Resistance
Regular 2.3 V 92Ω
When cut off 5.00 V 260Ω
When shorted 0.00 V 0Ω
Assessment
Criteria
Results
Regular : no break (OK)
Irregular : has a break (NG)
Irregular : shorted (NG)
4-S84
Regular : 12 V (OK)
Irregular : Large discrepancy from 12 V (NG)
RY9212001ELS0074US0
4-S85
Factory Spec
Float position F (a) 1/2 (b) E (c)
Resistance value (Ω) 3 ±1 32.5 110 ±2.5
Assessment
Criteria
Results
Regular : Within factory spec (OK)
Irregular : Outside factory spec (NG)
4-S86
[Test Conditions]
1. Key switch : ON
3. Tester mode
1. Select the tester mode.
2. Start the engine.
3. Check the display for the voltage and temperature of the water
based on the following table.
Water temperature
Water temperature
voltage
Regular 1.0 V 86 °C, 187 °F
When cut off 5.00 V –50 °C, –58 °F
When shorted 0.00 V 150 °C, 302 °F
Assessment
Criteria
Results
Regular : no break (OK)
Irregular : has a break (NG)
Irregular : shorted (NG)
4-S87
Regular : 5V (OK)
Irregular : Large discrepancy from 5V (NG)
RY9212001ELS0082US0
4-S88
Assessment
Criteria
Results
Regular : Within factory spec (OK)
Irregular : Outside factory spec (NG)
4-S89
4-S90
Assessment
Criteria
Results
Regular : no break (OK)
Irregular : has a break (NG)
Irregular : shorted (NG)
2. Checking relays
1. Checking relays is not necessary.
RY9212001ELS0009US0
4-S91
(a) Lever lock solenoid connector (b) Lever lock switch connector
CN12 CN11
RY9212001ELS0089US0
4-S92
Regular : 12 V (OK)
Irregular : Large discrepancy from 12 V (NG)
RY9212001ELS0091US0
4-S93
Regular : 12 V (OK)
Irregular : Large discrepancy from 12 V (NG)
RY9212001ELS0093US0
4-S94
Assessment
Criteria
Results
Regular : no break (OK)
Irregular : has a break (NG)
4-S95
3. Tester mode
1. Select the tester mode.
2. Start the engine.
3. Put the machinery operation lever lock in the [Unlock] position
and press the 2-speed switch.
4. Operate the 2-speed switch and check the 2-speed switch and
2-speed solenoid based on the following table.
2- 2- When 2-
Regu- When
speed speed shorte speed
lar cut off
lamp lamp d lamp
2-speed switch
Lit Lit Off
ON
2-speed switch
Off Off Off
OFF
2-speed
Lit Lit Off
solenoid ON
2-speed
Off Off Off
solenoid OFF
Assessment
Criteria
Results
Regular : no break (OK)
Irregular : has a break (NG)
Irregular : shorted (NG)
4-S96
4-S97
Regular : 12 V (OK)
Irregular : Large discrepancy from 12 V (NG)
RY9212001ELS0102US0
Regular : 12 V (OK)
Irregular : Large discrepancy from 12 V (NG)
RY9212001ELS0104US0
4-S98
Assessment
Criteria
Results
Regular : Within factory spec (OK)
Irregular : Outside factory spec (NG)
4-S99
(1) 2 Speed SW
2 Speed SOL
Lever Lock SW
Lever Lock SOL
Air Cleaner
RY9212032ELS0018US0
4. Erasing failure history
1. After completing repairs, select Erase Failure History and erase
the records.
2. After erasing the records, read the failure history again and
make sure there are no failures.
Assessment
Criteria
Results
Regular : Failure history erased (OK)
Irregular : failure history not erased
(NG)
4-S100
3. Tester mode
1. Select the tester mode.
2. Start the engine.
3. Turn the accelerator dial to the right (hi-speed) and to the left
(lo-speed) and check the governor pot voltage based on the
following table.
Design Governor When
Regular When cut off
Value POT shorted
Idling 1.68 +/- 0.2 V 0.05 V Voltage fails to
KX057-4
MAX 3.39 +/- 0.28 V 0.05 V stabilize
Assessment
Criteria
Results
Regular : no break (OK)
Irregular : has a break (NG)
Irregular : shorted (NG)
4-S101
4-S102
Regular : 5V (OK)
Irregular : Large discrepancy from 5V (NG)
RY9212001ELS0162US0
2. Continuity check
[Measurement Conditions]
1. Key switch : OFF
2. Disconnect the governor sensor connector CN4.
3. Disconnect the ECU connector CN1.
4. Test the continuity based on the table below.
Connector
Mea- Connector Assess-
Name Pin
sure- Name Pin No. ment
(+ terminal No.
ment (- terminal side) Results
side)
Governor sensor ECU connector
(a) <2> <8>
connector CN4 CN1
Governor sensor ECU connector
(b) <1> <16>
connector CN4 CN1
Governor sensor ECU connector
(c) <3> <20>
connector CN4 CN1
4-S103
<1> – <2>
Measurement(b)
<2> – <3>
(1) AI Set
AUX Set
AUX2/Thumb Set
RY9212032ELS0005US0
3. Erasing failure history
1. After completing repairs, select Erase Failure History and erase
the records.
2. After erasing the records, read the failure history again and
make sure there are no failures.
Assessment
Criteria
Results
Regular : Failure history erased (OK)
Irregular : failure history not erased
(NG)
4-S104
3. Tester mode
1. Select the tester mode.
2. Start the engine.
3. Turn the accelerator dial to the right (hi-speed) and to the left
(lo-speed) and check the accelerator POT voltage based on the
following table.
Design Governor When
Regular When cut off
Value POT shorted
Idling 1.68 +/- 0.2 V 0.05 V Voltage fails to
KX057-4
MAX 3.39 +/- 0.28 V 0.05 V stabilize
Assessment
Criteria
Results
Regular : no break (OK)
Irregular : has a break (NG)
Irregular : shorted (NG)
4-S105
Regular : 5V (OK)
Irregular : Large discrepancy from 5V (NG)
RY9212001ELS0167US0
4-S106
4-S107
Assessment
Criteria
Results
Regular : Within factory spec (OK)
Irregular : Outside factory spec (NG)
(1) AI Set
AUX Set
AUX2/Thumb Set
RY9212032ELS0005US0
3. Erasing failure history
1. After completing repairs, select Erase Failure History and erase
the records.
2. After erasing the records, read the failure history again and
make sure there are no failures.
Assessment
Criteria
Results
Regular : Failure history erased (OK)
Irregular : failure history not erased
(NG)
4-S108
3. Tester mode
1. Select the tester mode.
2. Start the engine.
3. Turn the accelerator dial to the right (hi-speed) and to the left
(lo-speed) and check the AI motor amperage based on the
following table.
AI Motor Operating 0.0 to 15.0 A
Motor Amperage
AI Motor Stopped 0.0 to 2.0 A
Assessment
Criteria
Results
Regular : no break (OK)
Irregular : has a break (NG)
Irregular : shorted (NG)
4-S109
2. Checking relays
1. Replace either the left or the right AI motor relay.
After replacing it, check for normal operation.
Assessment
Criteria
Results
Regular : no break (OK)
Irregular : has a break (NG)
4-S110
Regular : 12 V (OK)
Irregular : Large discrepancy from 12 V (NG)
RY9212001ELS0175US0
2. Voltage check-2
[Measurement Conditions]
1. Remove the AI motor fuse (15A).
2. Key switch : ON
3. Measure the voltage based on the table below.
Connector
Mea- Connector Assess-
Name Pin
sure- Name Pin No. ment
(+ terminal No.
ment (- terminal side) Results
side)
AI motor fuse
(b) (15A), fuse box <1> Body GND –
side
Regular : 12 V (OK)
Irregular : Large discrepancy from 12 V (NG)
(a) AI motor fuse (15A)
RY9212001ELS0176US0
3. Voltage check-3
[Measurement Conditions]
1. Remove the AI motor relay.
2. Key switch : ON
3. Measure the voltage based on the table below.
Connector
Mea- Connector Assess-
Name Pin
sure- Name Pin No. ment
(+ terminal No.
ment (- terminal side) Results
side)
AI motor relay
(a) <5> Body GND –
fuse box side
Regular : 12 V (OK)
Irregular : Large discrepancy from 12 V (NG)
RY9212001ELS0177US0
4-S111
4-S112
(1) AI Set
AUX Set
AUX2/Thumb Set
RY9212032ELS0022US0
4. Erasing failure history
1. After completing repairs, select Erase Failure History and erase
the records.
2. After erasing the records, read the failure history again and
make sure there are no failures.
Assessment
Criteria
Results
Regular : Failure history erased (OK)
Irregular : failure history not erased
(NG)
4-S113
Assessment
Criteria
Results
Regular : no break (OK)
Irregular : has a break (NG)
Irregular : shorted (NG)
4-S114
Regular : 12 V (OK)
Irregular : Large discrepancy from 12 V (NG)
RY9212001ELS0187US0
4-S115
(1) AI Set
AUX Set
AUX2/Thumb Set
RY9212032ELS0005US0
4-S116
4-S117
Assessment
Criteria
Results
Regular : no break (OK)
Irregular : has a break (NG)
Irregular : shorted (NG)
4-S118
Regular : 12 V (OK)
Irregular : Large discrepancy from 12 V (NG)
RY9212001ELS0193US0
4-S119
4-S120
(1) AI Set
AUX Set
AUX2/Thumb Set
RY9212032ELS0005US0
3. Erasing failure history
1. After completing repairs, select Erase Failure History and erase
the records.
2. After erasing the records, read the failure history again and
make sure there are no failures.
Assessment
Criteria
Results
Regular : Failure history erased (OK)
Irregular : failure history not erased
(NG)
4-S121
Ex.) Antenna
(1) Ant-theft Sys Err (a) Warning lamp
(b) Info button
RY9212032ELS0025US0
[Test Conditions]
1. Key switch : OFF
2. Check whether the anti-theft indicator is blinking or not.
(a) Anti-theft indicator
RY9212001ELS0198US0
3. Tester mode
1. Select the tester mode.
2. Check the anti-theft antenna.
Regular Irregular
Anti-theft antenna OK NG
On/off Valid cancel OK OK NG OK
Red key Black key – OK – –
4-S122
4-S123
[Measurement Conditions]
1. Disconnect the anti-theft connector CN441.
2. Key switch : ON
3. Measure the voltage based on the table below.
Mea- Assess-
Pin
sure- Connector Name (+ terminal side) Connector Name (- terminal side) Pin No. ment
No.
ment Results
(a) Anti-theft connector CN441 <5> Anti-theft connector CN441 <2>
(b) Anti-theft connector CN441 <5> Body GND –
(c) Anti-theft connector CN441 <6> Anti-theft connector CN441 <2>
(d) Anti-theft connector CN441 <6> Body GND –
Regular : 5V (OK)
Irregular : Large discrepancy from 5V (NG)
RY9212001ELS0203US0
4-S124
[Measurement Conditions]
1. Key switch : OFF
2. Disconnect the anti-theft connector CN441.
3. Disconnect the ECU connector CN1.
4. Test the continuity based on the table below.
Mea- Assess-
Pin
sure- Connector Name (+ terminal side) Connector Name (- terminal side) Pin No. ment
No.
ment Results
(a) Anti-theft connector CN441 <1> ECU connector CN1 <31>
(b) Anti-theft connector CN441 <2> ECU connector CN1 <2>
(c) Anti-theft connector CN441 <3> ECU connector CN1 <38>
(d) Anti-theft connector CN441 <4> ECU connector CN1 <13>
(e) Anti-theft connector CN441 <5> ECU connector CN1 <11>
(f) Anti-theft connector CN441 <6> ECU connector CN1 <19>
4-S125
4-S126
4-S127
Ex.) External 5 V
(1) External 5V Sys Err (a) Warning lamp
(b) Info button
RY9212032ELS0028US0
[Test Conditions]
1. Check whether each line is pinched against or touching the body If the insulation is damaged, repair it properly
and check the meter display again.
4-S128
[Test Conditions]
1. Check whether each line is pinched against or touching the body If the insulation is damaged, repair it properly
and check the meter display again.
4-S129
3. Tester mode
1. Select the tester mode.
2. Confirm the ECU is O.
Regular Irregular
ECU (main) OK NG
Assessment
Criteria
Results
Regular : no break (OK)
Irregular : has a break (NG)
Irregular : shorted (NG)
4-S130
2. Checking relays
1. Checking relays is not necessary.
RY9212001ELS0009US0
3. Causes when a break in wiring
1. Checking for breaks in wiring is not necessary.
RY9212001ELS0220US0
4. Causes when a short
[Test Conditions]
1. Key switch : OFF
2. The CAN connector CN6 wire is pinched against or touching the
body. If the insulation is damaged, repair it properly and check
the ECU (main) again in the tester mode.
Assessment
Criteria
Results
Regular : no break (OK)
When shorted : has a break (NG)
4-S131
4-S132
4-S133
Assessment
Criteria
Results
Regular : no break (OK)
Irregular : has a break (NG)
Irregular : shorted (NG)
4-S134
4-S135
Regular : 12 V (OK)
Irregular : Large discrepancy from 12 V (NG)
RY9212050ELS0043US0
2. Voltage check (AUX1 / AUX2 Switch)
[Measurement Conditions]
1. Disconnect the AUX1 / AUX2 switch connector CN422.
2. Key switch : ON
3. Measure the voltage based on the table below.
Connector
Mea- Connector Assess-
Name Pin
sure- Name Pin No. ment
(+ terminal No.
ment (- terminal side) Results
side)
AUX1 / AUX2 AUX1 / AUX2
(a) switch connector <1> switch connector <2>
CN422 CN422
AUX1 / AUX2
(b) switch connector <1> Body GND –
CN422
Regular : 5 V (OK)
Irregular : Large discrepancy from 5 V (NG)
RY9212050ELS0045US0
3. Continuity check (AUX one way hold Switch)
[Measurement Conditions]
1. Key switch : OFF
2. Disconnect the AUX1 / AUX2 switch connector CN422.
3. Disconnect the ECU connector CN1.
4. Test the continuity based on the table below.
Connector
Mea- Connector Assess-
Name Pin
sure- Name Pin No. ment
(+ terminal No.
ment (- terminal side) Results
side)
AUX1 / AUX2
ECU connector
(a) switch connector <5> <11>
CN1
CN422
AUX1 / AUX2
ECU connector
(b) switch connector <6> <59>
CN1
CN422
4-S136
4-S137
Assessment
Criteria
Results
Regular : no break (OK)
Irregular : has a break (NG)
4-S139
CAUTION
• Remove the battery code before starting the maintenance
and inspection.
• Re-setting is required for the digital meter clock because it
stops when the battery code is removed.
RY9212032ELS0035US0
4-S140
(1) Battery isolator (Battery (2) Bolt (4) Slow-blow fuse box (5) Nut
connection switch) (3) Battery cable
RY9212032ELS0036US0
4-S141
CONTENTS
(1) Control Panel (4) Cabin Air Inlet (7) Air Conditioning Unit (10) Receiver
(2) Outside Air Inlet (5) In/Outside Air Duct (8) Compressor (11) Heater Core
(3) Outside Air Duct (6) Air Duct ASSY (9) Condenser
The cabin is equipped with a high-capacity, low-profile air conditioner that can circulate cabin air or bring in fresh
air from outside.
Cabin air is sucked into the cabin air inlet (4), which is located behind the seat; it then passes through the
in/outside air duct (5) to the air conditioning unit (7) (cabin air circulation). Fresh air is taken in via the outside air inlet
(2) and passes through the in/outside air duct (5) and enters the air conditioning unit (7) (fresh air intake).
The inside or outside air that is sucked into the air conditioning unit (7) is cooled and dehumidified by the cooler of
the air conditioning unit (7).
When the system is used for heating, the air is heated by the heater core (11) and then expelled from the air duct
ASSY (6). The vents installed inside the cabin can be opened and closed as well as adjusted to blow in different
directions.
5-M1
RY9212001CAM0001US0
5-M2
(1) Capillary Tube (heat sensitive (4) Blower Motor (9) Dryer A : Cooled Air
capillary tube) (5) Compressor (10) Pressure Switch B : Low pressure and
(2) Expansion Valve (6) Engine Cooling Fan (11) Heater Core temperature vapor
(3) Evaporator (7) Condenser (12) Hot Water Valve C, D : Air passes through
(8) Receiver in / outside air filter
E : High pressure/temperature
gas
F : Hot Air
G : Liquid
5-M3
[3] COMPRESSOR
The vane type of compressor installed in this system
is composed of a cylinder (1) that is elliptical in
cross-section, along with five vanes (3) attached to the
rotor (2). This vane compressor has two each of intake
and discharge ports.
The five vanes (3) are attached to the rotor (2) and
as it rotates, the tips of the vanes come in contact with
the walls of the cylinder (1) and an airtight compression
space is maintained both by the centrifugal force exerted
by the rotor (2) along with the back pressure on the
vanes (3), which is in proportion to the rpms of the rotor
(2).
As a result, the volume changes in each of the five
segments of the cylinder, which are divided by the five
vanes (3) in the cylinder (1).
Each time that the rotor (2) rotates, each of the five
segments of the cylinder goes through two cycles of
intake, compression and discharge.
(1) Cylinder (3) Vane
(2) Rotor
RY9212001CAM0003US0
How it Works
As the rotor (3) turns, the volume of space in a
segment, as divided by the cylinder (1) and vanes (4),
increases, sucking refrigerant gas from the intake port
(2) into the cylinder space.
As the rotor (3) turns further, the volume of the space
created between the cylinder (1) and vanes (4)
decreases, compressing the refrigerant gas. As the rotor
(3) continues to turn, the refrigerant gas is compressed
further, putting it under a great deal of pressure, pressing
on the discharge valve and opening it. The refrigerant
gas is then expelled via the discharge port (5).
(1) Cylinder (A) Compression Cycle
(2) Intake Port (B) Discharge Cycle
(3) Rotor (C) Intake Cycle
(4) Vane
(5) Discharge Port
RY9212001CAM0004US0
Compressor Oil
The compressor oil is dissolved in the refrigerant and circulates throughout the entire cooling system acting as
the lubricating oil for the compressor. However, because the previously used R12 compressor oil does not dissolve
in R134a, it does not circulate through the cooling cycle. So it drastically reduces the working life of the compressor.
As a result, it is imperative that the right compressor oil is always used. The mineral oil that is used in an R12
cooling system cannot be used in an R134a cooling system. A synthetic PAG oil has to be used in an R134a cooling
system. This oil mixes extremely well with refrigerant gas and provides the entire system with the optimum lubrication.
Volume of Oil Product Name
110 to 120 cc
ND–OIL8 <PAG* oil>
0.116 to 0.127 U.S.qts
*PAG : Polyalkylene glycol (synthetic oil)
RY9212001CAM0005US0
5-M4
5-M5
5-M6
The air conditioning unit is composed of an evaporator, an expansion valve, a heater core, a blower, etc.
No. Name of part Notes No. Name of part Notes
(1) Case, air conditioning unit Top case (15) Pipe
(2) Case, air conditioning unit Evaporator (16) Hot water valve
(3) Case, air conditioning unit Bottom case (17) Clip D24
(4) Case, air conditioning unit Linkage cover (18) Screw, W/washer M4, L10
(5) Case, air conditioning unit Intake cover (19) O-Rings ID15.8
(6) Evaporator (20) Servo motor Temperature control
(7) O-Rings 1/2" 134A (21) Linkage lever
(8) O-Rings 5/8" 134A (22) Blower resistor Plate
(9) Expansion valve BOX 1.0 ton (23) Tapping screw D5, L16
(10) Bolt For expansion valve (24) Tapping screw D4, L16
(11) Thermistor (25) Cap (plug) For expansion valve
(12) Clamp For thermistor (26) Blower motor
(13) AC Amp (27) Wire harness
(14) Heater core
5-M7
B. Heater Core
The heater core dissipates the heat of the heated
engine coolant. So, the air that is blown through it by the
blower motor passes through the fins of the heater core
and the air takes on the heat of the coolant.
(1) Heater Core (A) Inlet
(B) Outlet
RY9212001CAM0011US0
C. Blower
The blower is built into the right side of the AC unit.
The blower forces cool, warm or fresh outside air through
the vents into the cabin.
The rpm of the blower motor can be adjusted to three
levels with the blower resistor. The blower fan is the type
that uses centrifugal force and it sucks in air parallel to
its axis of rotation and blows it out perpendicular to the
centrifugal force, or in other words, perpendicular to the
axis of rotation.
Specifications (at 20 °C)
Model DC Ferrite
Rated Voltage 12 V
No load RPM 4300 ± 400 rpm
No load amperage 1 to 3 A
Direction of rotation (viewed
Left
from drive side)
Rated load torque 461 N·m, 47.0 kgf·m, 340 lbf·ft
RPM 2800 ± 280 rpm
Amperage 18.3 ± 1.8A
5-M8
5-M9
5-M10
Usage Conditions
Temperature
–30 to 80 °C (–22 to 176 °F)
Range
Voltage Range DC10 to 16 V
Operating Voltage
DC8 to 16 V (at 25 °C, 77 °F)
Range
Temperature 10 °C 15 °C 20 °C 25 °C 30 °C
Detection / 50 °F / 59 °F / 68 °F / 77 °F / 86 °F
2.96 2.34 1.87 1.50 1.22
Resistance Value
kΩ kΩ kΩ kΩ kΩ
5-M11
[5] CONDENSER
The hot, compressed refrigerant is under high
pressure and in a gaseous state; the condenser cools it
and returns it to a liquid state. In the interval between
entering and passing through the condenser, the
refrigerant is cooled and becomes liquid refrigerant
again. At this point, it is necessary to be sure the
refrigerant is liquid at the outlet of the condenser. If the
refrigerant is not condensed enough in the condenser
some refrigerant would be in a gaseous state and that
would reduce the AC's cooling efficiency.
(1) Tubes (a) Gaseous refrigerant
(2) Fins (b) Liquid refrigerant
(3) Vapor (c) Inlet (180 °C, 176 °F)
(4) Vapor/liquid mix (d) Outlet (50 °C, 122 °F)
(5) Liquid
RY9212001CAM0018US0
5-M12
[6] RECEIVER
The receiver is composed of a receiver tank, dryer,
strainer and a receiver tube.
[Receiver Tank]
In the AC system, the rpm of the compressor
changes in response to changes in the engine rpm, so
the appropriate amount of refrigerant in the cooling
circuit also changes. The receiver tank is the part that
reacts to those changes; when a lot of refrigerant is not
required in the cooling circuit, excess refrigerant is
stored temporarily in the tank and when more coolant is
needed, it is supplied to the circuit via the receiver tube.
It also acts to store the balance of refrigerant
charges and for extra refrigerant to counteract the leak
of small amounts of refrigerant, such as via permeation
of rubber hoses.
[Dryer]
If any moisture exists in the cooling circuit, it
damages the system by deteriorating the valves of the
compressor, its oil, by corroding metal parts in the circuit,
and/or freezes in the expansion valve and blocks the
circuit. The AC system uses synthetic zeolite as a dryer
that is compatible with the circuit, and it absorbs any
moisture that gets mixed into the circuit during
installation or charging of refrigerant.
If the expansion valve freezes up frequently due to
moisture (icing), it means the dryer has lost its ability to
absorb it, so the receiver has to be replaced.
[Strainer]
If dirt gets into the cooling circuit, it blocks the
expansion valve, damages the compressor and
otherwise hampers its cooling function. The strainer
works to prevent any dirt flowing in the refrigerant from
going any further. The strainer cannot be cleaned, so
when it becomes severely clogged up, (in which case the
high pressure gets high, low pressure gets low), the
receiver has to be changed.
[Sight Glass]
The sight glass is mounted at the receiver joint on
top of the receiver and it is the only place in the circuit
where the amount of refrigerant can be visually
inspected.
(1) Dryer (A) Refrigerant inlet
(2) Receiver tube (B) Refrigerant outlet
(3) Strainer
(4) Receiver tank
RY9212001CAM0019US0
5-M13
5-M14
O Dry Heat
1. Press the AC switch to operate the AC.
2. Turn the fan switch to operate the fan.
3. Turn the temperature control dial to the right (warm
air) and adjust the air temperature.
NOTE
• Keep the door closed while operating the AC.
O Cooling
1. Press the AC switch to operate the AC.
2. Turn the fan switch to operate the fan.
3. Turn the temperature control dial to the left (cool air)
and adjust the air temperature.
NOTE
• The moisture from dehumidifying the cabin
collects in the AC unit and is expelled outside the
machine.
• The idle boost function operates when the
compressor is operating.
O Defrost
To eliminate fog or frost from the front window,
1. open the front vents and point them toward the front
window.
2. Turn the fan switch to [3] and the temperature control
dial to the right (warm air).
(1) Temperature control dial (3) AC switch
(2) Indicator lamp (4) Fan switch
RY9212001CAM0021US0
5-M15
5-M16
(1) Battery (13) Blower switch (shorting type) (A) Fixed voltage circuit (h) (free)
(2) Slow-blow Fuse (80A) (14) Compressor clutch relay (B) Servo motor drive circuit (i) Servo motor output1
(3) Slow-blow Fuse (50A) (15) Pressure Switch (C) CPU (COOL output)
(4) Fuse (5A) (16) Compressor magnetic clutch (D) Electronic thermo amp (j) (free)
(5) Fuse (10A) (17) Fin thermistor (frost sensor) (k) Servo motor output2
(6) Fuse (30A) (18) Indicator lamp (a) Potentiometer signal (HOT output)
(7) Start switch (19) AC switch (b) ILL– (l) (free)
(8) Cab relay (20) Volume (temperature setting) (c) Potentiometer power (m) (free)
(9) Headlight switch (21) Servo motor (d) Blower motor (n) Headlight switch
(10) Blower Motor Relay (e) Potentiometer GND (o) IG
(11) Blower Motor (f) Electronic thermo (p) +B power
(12) Blower resistor (g) GND
The processes up to the compressor's magnetic clutch engaging are indicated below.
1. Start switch → cab relay ON → blower motor relay ON → blower switch ON (LO, MI or HI) →blower motor ON
2. AC switch ON (indicator lamp lights up) → pressure switch ON → fin thermistor ON →
compressor clutch relay ON → compressor magnetic clutch ON (compressor operates)
RY9212001CAM0024US0
5-M17
(2) Relays
Current flows in the components of the AC system to
the blower motor and compressor's magnetic clutch. If all
of the current were supplied via the main switch, the
current would be too much for the switch, so the contacts
of the main switch would be in danger of burning out.
Similarly, if this current flowed directly from the battery
and the operator forget to turn the blower motor off, the
battery would discharge.
The system is equipped with relays in order to
prevent these kind of problems. When the current flows
through the coils of these relays, their contacts close,
allowing electricity to be supplied from the battery. By
adopting these relays, only a tiny amount of current is
needed to operate the relays, so very little current flows
through the main switch. As a result, the concern over its
contacts burning out is eliminated and when the main
switch is open, the relays' contacts open at the same
time. When this occurs, the flow of electricity in the AC
circuit ceases and the possibility of the battery
discharging is also eliminated.
(a) Relay terminal 5 (A) Connection diagram
(b) Relay terminal 3 (UISO relay)
(c) Relay terminal 2
(d) Relay terminal 1
RY9212001CAM0025US0
5-M18
(1) Battery (9) Headlight switch (16) Compressor magnetic clutch (A) Fixed voltage circuit
(2) Slow-blow Fuse (80A) (10) Blower Motor Relay (17) Fin thermistor (frost sensor) (B) Servo motor drive circuit
(3) Slow-blow Fuse (50A) (11) Blower Motor (18) Indicator lamp (C) CPU
(4) Fuse (5A) (12) Blower resistor (19) AC switch (D) Electronic thermo amp
(5) Fuse (10A) (13) Blower switch (shorting type) (20) Volume (temperature setting)
(6) Fuse (30A) (14) Compressor clutch relay (21) Servo motor
(7) Start switch (15) Pressure Switch
(8) Cab relay
When the starter switch and the blower switch are turned on, electricity flows from the battery to the coil of the
blower motor relay, turning the blower motor relay on. With the blower motor relay on, the electricity flows to the
blower motor as indicated below.
O Lo Position
• Battery → slow-blow fuse (80A) → slow-blow fuse (50A) → fuse (30A) → blower motor relay → blower motor →
blower resistor → ground
O Mi Position
• Battery → slow-blow fuse (80A) → slow-blow fuse (50A) → fuse (30A) → blower motor relay → blower motor →
blower resistor → blower switch (E→A) → ground
O Hi Position
• Battery → slow-blow fuse (80A) → slow-blow fuse (50A) → fuse (30A) → blower motor relay → blower motor →
blower resistor → blower switch (F→A) → ground
RY9212001CAM0026US0
5-M19
2. WIPER
[1] WIPER SWITCH
This switch has four positions, namely (a), (b), (c),
and (d) as indicated in the figure. When the starter key is
in its [RUN] position and the switch is pressed to its (b)
position, the wiper motor operates; pressing it in further
to its (a) position operates the window washer. When the
operator releases the switch, it automatically returns
from position (a) to position (b).
The window washer also operates if it is pressed in
to position (d) on the [OFF] side. When it is released, it
automatically returns in the same way to position (c).
(1) Switch (a) Wash 1 position
(2) Spring (both wiper motor and
(3) Contact window washer operate)
(4) Switch body (b) On position (only the wiper
(5) Movable contact motor operates)
(6) Insulator (c) Off position
(d) Wash 2 position (only the
window washer operates)
RY9212001CAM0027US0
[2] WIPER
The wiper is composed of a motor, wiper arm, wiper
blade, etc.
The motor is fixed speed and automatically returns to
a set position.
(1) Washer (5) Wiper blade
(2) Nut (6) Wiper motor
(3) Wiper arm (7) Wiper motor cover
(4) Nut (8) Flange nut
RY9212001CAM0028US0
5-M20
5-M21
CONTENTS
1. TROUBLESHOOTING.................................................................................................................5-S1
2. MAINTENANCE AND SERVICE RELATED SPECIFICATIONS.................................................5-S4
3. TORQUE .....................................................................................................................................5-S5
4. PRECAUTIONS WHEN REPAIRING THE REFRIGERANT SYSTEM .......................................5-S6
[1] USE OF SERVICE TOOLS ...................................................................................................5-S6
(1) Manifold Gauge Set.........................................................................................................5-S6
(2) Refrigerant charging hoses .............................................................................................5-S9
(3) Vacuum Pump Adapter .................................................................................................5-S10
(4) Electric Gas Leak Tester ...............................................................................................5-S10
(5) Canister Tap Valve ........................................................................................................5-S10
(6) T-Joint............................................................................................................................5-S11
(7) R134a Refrigerant Collection/Recycling Device............................................................5-S11
5. INSPECTING AND CHARGING THE REFRIGERANT SYSTEM .............................................5-S12
[1] CHECKING THE SYSTEM WITH A MANIFOLD GAUGE...................................................5-S12
[2] COLLECTION, VACUUMING AND CHARGING.................................................................5-S16
(1) Collecting Refrigerant ....................................................................................................5-S16
(2) Vacuuming out the System............................................................................................5-S16
(3) Charging from the High-pressure Side ..........................................................................5-S18
(4) Charging from the Low-Pressure Side ..........................................................................5-S18
(5) Inspections and Troubleshooting...................................................................................5-S19
6. INSPECTION AND DISASSEMBLY..........................................................................................5-S21
[1] CHECKS AND ADJUSTMENTS .........................................................................................5-S21
(1) Compressor ...................................................................................................................5-S21
(2) Relays............................................................................................................................5-S21
(3) Blower motor .................................................................................................................5-S23
(4) Blower resistor...............................................................................................................5-S24
(5) Blower switch.................................................................................................................5-S25
(6) Servo Motor (for temp control).......................................................................................5-S26
(7) Pressure Switch.............................................................................................................5-S27
[2] DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY ......................................................................................5-S28
(1) Connecting / Disconnecting AC Hoses..........................................................................5-S29
(2) Mounting and Removing the Compressor .....................................................................5-S30
(3) Connecting / Disconnecting Hoses................................................................................5-S32
(4) Removing and Mounting the Receiver ..........................................................................5-S33
(5) Removing and Mounting AC Ducts ...............................................................................5-S34
(6) Removal and Installation of AC Cabin Air Inlets............................................................5-S36
7. CABIN REMOVAL AND MOUNTING ........................................................................................5-S38
[1] REMOVING THE CABIN .....................................................................................................5-S38
8. WINDOW WASHER ..................................................................................................................5-S40
[1] WIPER SWITCH..................................................................................................................5-S40
[2] COMPONENT SCHEMATIC ...............................................................................................5-S41
[3] WIPER MOTOR ..................................................................................................................5-S42
[4] WASHER MOTOR ..............................................................................................................5-S42
9. LIGHTING DEVICES (CAB WORK LIGHT, INTERIOR LIGHT)................................................5-S43
10. REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION OF GLASS ...........................................................................5-S46
[1] PREPARATION ...................................................................................................................5-S46
[2] REMOVING GLASS ............................................................................................................5-S46
[3] INSTALLING GLASS...........................................................................................................5-S47
[4] GLASS TRIM TYPE ............................................................................................................5-S48
1. TROUBLESHOOTING
Compressor
Problem and/or
Possible Cause Solution
Situation
Wearing of or damage to the compressor's
Replace
bearings
Compressor valve damaged Replace
Noise (compressor on)
Belt slipping Adjust or replace
Compressor bracket mounting bolt(s) loose Tighten
Lines vibrating Tighten and/or add clamp(s)
Blower damaged Repair or replace
Noise (compressor off) Magnetic clutch, idler pulley and/or crank pulley
Replace
bearings damaged or wearing
Not cooling effectively Not enough refrigerant Check with a manifold gauge
(lots of foam visible in Refrigerant gas leaking from the cooling circuit Repair and/or recharge refrigerant
sight glass) Air got in Check with a manifold gauge
Too much refrigerant
Refrigerant overcharged Check with a manifold gauge
(no foam in sight glass)
5-S1
Problem and/or
Possible Cause Solution
Situation
Thermistor broken Replace
Not cooling effectively Hot water valve damaged Replace
(other) Condenser clogged with dirt or debris Clean
Expansion valve broken Replace
Hot water valve damaged Replace
Not heating effectively
Servo motor broken Check and repair
Blower fan switch broken Check and repair
5-S2
Problem and/or
Possible Cause Solution
Situation
Not enough refrigerant Check with a manifold gauge
Not cooling effectively Frost on the evaporator Clean or replace
(low-pressure level too Error in the low-pressure line
low) Replace
(cracked or clogged)
Expansion valve clogged Replace
Not cooling effectively
(both low and high
Refrigerant overcharged Check with a manifold gauge
pressure levels too
high)
Not cooling effectively
(both low and high
Not enough refrigerant Check with a manifold gauge
pressure levels too
low)
Cannot control Servo motor broken Replace
temperature (servo Temperature control dial broken Replace
motor and/or
temperature control Controller of the wire harness is off Repair or replace
dial defective)
Cannot control the Servo motor broken Replace
temperature (hot water
valve does not open Hot water valve damaged Replace
normally)
Cannot control the Heater hose is pinched Fix
temperature (poor
heater hose layout) Heater hose is bent or broken Repair or replace
Water leak (water leak Drain hose bent or broken Check and repair
inside the cab) Drain hose clogged Clean
Wiper
Problem and/or
Possible Cause Solution
Situation
Fuse blown (a part inside the wiper motor or Pinpoint the cause of the damage
some other moving part is shorted or burned out) and replace
Wiper motor faulty (damaged armature, worn
Replace
motor brushes, motor shaft locked)
Wiper doesn't work
Wiper switch faulty Replace
Faulty operation of linkage mechanism due to
Fix
foreign matter
Wiper arm locked or rusted together Grease up or replace
Wiper motor faulty (damaged armature, poor
contact due to worn motor brushes, faulty Replace
operation of motor shaft)
Wiper moves too
slowly Battery voltage low Recharge or replace
Wiper arm shaft rusty, foreign matter stuck in it Grease up or replace
Poor contact in wiper switch Replace
Wiper motor faulty (Dirty or poor contact of the
Wiper fails to stop in
contacts at the auto-stop position due to foreign Replace
the correct position
matter)
RY9212001CAS0001US0
5-S3
2. MAINTENANCE AND
SERVICE RELATED SPECIFICATIONS
Allowable Limit
Item Factory spec.
Value
0.30 to 0.65 mm
AC Compressor Magnetic Clutch Air Gap –
0.0118 to 0.0255 in.
Electrical
Magnetic Clutch Stator Coil 3.0 to 4.0 Ω –
Resistance
0.15 to 0.20 MPa
Pressure
1.5 to 2.0 kgf/cm2 –
(low-pressure side)
Cooling Cycle 21 to 28 psi
(cooling cycle when operating normally) Pressure 1.27 to 1.66 MPa
(high-pressure 13 to 17 kgf/cm2 –
side) 185 to 242 psi
Lower than the values
below
Pressure setting
About 0.196 MPa –
(low-pressure side)
2.0 kgf/cm2
Pressure switch 28.4 psi
(dual type) (when pressure switch is off) Higher than the values
Pressure setting below
(high-pressure About 3.14 MPa –
side) 32 kgf/cm2
455 psi
Deflects 12 to 15 mm
(0.47 to 0.59 in.) when
AC drive belt Tension –
68.6 N (7 kgf, 15.4 lbf) of
forced is applied
R134a
Type
Refrigerant 0.65 to 0.75 kg –
(recharge volume)
1.43 to 1.65 lbs
ND-OIL8 <PAG*oil>
Type 100 to 120 cc
Compressor Oil –
(usage volume) 0.106 to 0.127 U.S.qts
0.088 to 0.106 Imp.qts
*PAG : Polyalkylene glycol (synthetic oil)
RY9212001CAS0002US0
5-S4
3. TORQUE
The following table indicates the specified tightening torque for nuts.
Items N·m kgf·m lbf·ft
M14 nut 107.9 to 125.5 11.0 to 12.8 79.6 to 92.6
Cabin mounting
M16 nut 166.7 to 191.2 17.0 to 19.5 123.0 to 141.0
Compressor mounting M8 bolt 16.7 to 19.6 1.7 to 2.0 12.3 to 14.5
Compressor bracket M12 bolt 77.5 to 90.2 7.9 to 9.2 57.1 to 66.5
mounting M8 bolt 16.7 to 19.6 1.7 to 2.0 12.3 to 14.5
Receiver mounting M6 bolt 3.9 to 6.9 0.4 to 0.7 2.9 to 5.1
High pressure line 1 M6 bolt 7.8 to 11.8 0.8 to 1.2 5.8 to 8.7
mounting (on condenser
side) M22 x 1.5 lock nut 19.6 to 24.5 2.0 to 2.5 14.5 to 18.1
Between condenser and M6 bolt 3.9 to 6.9 0.4 to 0.7 2.9 to 5.1
receiver M16 x 1.5 lock nut 11.8 to 14.7 1.2 to 1.5 8.7 to 10.8
High pressure line 2
mounting (on receiver M16 x 1.5 lock nut 11.8 to 14.7 1.2 to 1.5 8.7 to 10.8
side)
Low-pressure line M6 bolt 7.8 to 11.8 0.8 to 1.2 5.8 to 8.7
between AC and
compressor M24 x 1.5 lock nut 29.4 to 34.3 3.0 to 3.5 21.7 to 25.3
5-S5
CAUTION
• If the liquid refrigerant comes in contact with skin, it results in frostbite, so always be careful when
handling refrigerants. Always wear goggles when working on this system in order to protect your eyes.
• Refrigerant service containers are made very sturdy for safety. However, they can explode if handled
improperly. Always follow the instructions printed on their labels. In particular, never heat a refrigerant
container above 40 °C (104 °F). Also, never drop one from any height.
• Do not steam clean this system. In particular, this system is under extremely high pressure, so do not
steam clean the condenser as it may cause the system to explode.
• If an error is made in handling the service valve or in connecting a hose between the compressor's
service valve and a manifold gauge, it may cause the refrigerant service container or the charging hose
to explode. When connecting hoses or handling service valves, always check the pressure on the
high-pressure side or on the low-pressure side.
• When recharging refrigerant with the compressor operating, do not open the high-pressure valve of the
manifold gauge.
• Be careful of gas toxicity. The refrigerant gas in its natural state is harmless and is not toxic. However,
when it comes in contact with very hot parts, it can break down chemically, producing hazardous
materials.
• Do not heat service canisters unless absolutely necessary. When necessary to heat a canister, use water
at or below 40 °C (104 °F). Never use boiling water to heat a canister.
IMPORTANT
• Using R12 refrigerant in an R134a AC system may cause problems to result, such as leaks of refrigerant
at O-rings and fogging of the sight glass. Consequently, the shapes of line joints, service valves and
service tools are different in order to prevent mistakes in connecting or recharging the wrong system.
• Always keep the work area clean, dry and free of any dirt or dust. Always wipe off any water from line
fittings with a clean cloth before opening the fitting.
• Only use R134a refrigerant service tools.
• When discharging refrigerant, use an R134a refrigerant collection/recycling machine.
• Prior to connecting a charging hose to the tap valve of a refrigerant canister, check each seal and make
sure it is not clogged up.
• When disconnecting charging hoses from compressor and receiver valves, do so as quickly as possible
to minimize the leakage of gas.
• Be careful to only charge with the specified amount of refrigerant; never overcharge the system. This is
important because overcharging the refrigerant can cause poor cooling performance among other
things.
• Hand tighten when connecting the charging hose to the canister's tap valve. Do not use pliers to tighten
the charging hose.
• Store refrigerant containers in a cool, dark place and never leave them in direct sunlight or in a hot place.
• R134a compressor oil readily absorbs moisture, so always seal any parts after disconnecting them.
• Do not use any of the old style R12 refrigerant or previous kinds of refrigerant compressor oil.
5-S6
CAUTION
• Take care with the following points on storing and handling service canisters.
• Store in a cool, dry place.
• Never drop or strike a canister.
• Do not use service canisters that are deformed, have unusable screws or are otherwise damaged.
• Never heat a service canister unless necessary. If one must be heated for some reason, use water at
or below 40 °C (In such cases, never warm the canister while heating the water.) Do not immerse the
valve of the service canister in water. Do not turn the service canister upside down. Turning it upside
down allows liquid refrigerant into the compressor, which damages the valve.
• Do not shake hard. (If the mounting of the valve is not secure, it may come off.)
• Use ND-OIL8 (made by DENSO (Co. Ltd.)) compressor oil. (ND-OIL6 is designated for use with R12, so
do not mistakenly use ND-OIL6.)
CAUTION
• Precautions on Inspecting and Charging AC Gas
• Perform all work in a well-ventilated location.
• Be careful when handling high-pressure valves. When recharging refrigerant with the engine running,
do not open the high-pressure valve (HI) of the manifold gauge. Overcharging refrigerant may cause
problems such as poor cooling and overheating.
IMPORTANT
• Collection of Refrigerant (AC gas)
In line with the Freon Collection and Destruction Law (Oct. 1, 2007), registration (Category 1 Freon
Collector) is required with the prefectural and municipal governments prior to collecting refrigerants with
a gas collection device, so do not perform this work if you are not registered. For details, contact the
relevant office in the prefectural and municipal governments.
RY9212001CAS0004US0
The manifold gauge set has a valve handle for opening and
closing valves. The valve handle marked LO is for use on the
low-pressure valve (5) and the valve handle marked HI is for use on
the high-pressure valve (3). The following circuits can be achieved
by variously opening and closing the high and low pressure valves.
(1) Low-pressure gauge (4) Valve core
(2) High-pressure gauge (5) Low-pressure valve
(3) High-pressure valve
RY9212001CAS0005US0
CAUTION
• Be sure to open the valve core (d).
(1) Low-pressure gauge (2) High-pressure gauge
RY9212001CAS0006US0
5-S7
CAUTION
• Be sure to open the valve core (D).
(1) Low-pressure gauge (2) High-pressure gauge
RY9212001CAS0007US0
With the low-pressure valve closed and the high-pressure
valve open
The following 2 circuits are formed.
Port (C) → Low-pressure gauge (1)
Port (C) → Port (B)
Port (C) → Port (D) (Be sure to open the valve core.)
Port (A) → High-pressure gauge (2)
CAUTION
• Be sure to open the valve core (D).
(1) Low-pressure gauge (2) High-pressure gauge
RY9212001CAS0008US0
With low and high pressure valves open
The following 2 circuits are formed.
Port (A) → High-pressure gauge (2)
Port (A) → Low-pressure gauge (1)
Port (A) → Port (B)
Port (A) → Port (C)
Port (A) → Port (D) (Be sure to open the valve core.)
CAUTION
• Be sure to open the valve core (D).
(1) Low-pressure gauge (2) High-pressure gauge
RY9212001CAS0009US0
5-S8
CAUTION
• While pressing in to make a connection, be careful not to
bend any lines.
• When connecting a quick-disconnect adapter, if you move
the sleeve (7) before the quick-link connector is connected
to the charge valve, move the sleeve back to its original
position and then try making the connection again.
• If there is any refrigerant left in the refrigerant charging
hose, it can be difficult to connect the quick-link connector.
In this case, make the connection after relieving the
pressure remaining in the refrigerant charging hose.
(Pressing on the pusher (8) eliminates any remaining
pressure.)
(When disconnecting)
• With part A of the quick-disconnect adaptor held in place, slide
part B up.
CAUTION
• After removing the quick-disconnect adaptor, be sure to
put a cap on the service valve of the adaptor.
(1) Low-pressure valve (7) Sleeve
(2) High-pressure valve (8) Pusher
(3) Red hose (9) Sleeve
(4) Quick-disconnect adapter
(5) Green hose a : Makes a catching sound
(6) Blue hose
RY9212001CAS0010US0
5-S9
5-S10
(6) T-Joint
A T-joint (2) is used when using two refrigerant canisters (4) at
the same time to make gas recharging more efficient.
1. Attach a refrigerant canister service valve on each side of the
T-joint (2) and connect a refrigerant charging hose (1) to the
T-joint.
(1) Refrigerant charging hose (green) (3) Canister tap valve
(2) T-joint (4) Refrigerant canister
RY9212001CAS0014US0
5-S11
CAUTION
• Use the refrigerant pressure in the refrigerant cycle to
completely flush out the air in the refrigerant charging hose
from the end of the manifold gauge's connection.
3. Start up the engine and set it at approximately 1,500 rpms.
4. Turn the AC switch on and set the temperature control dial to the
max cooling position.
5. Set the blower switch to its HI position.
(1) Refrigerant charging hose (5) Manifold gauge
(blue or yellow) (6) Low-pressure side charge valve
(2) Refrigerant charging hose (red) (7) High-pressure side charge valve
(3) High-pressure valve
(4) Low-pressure valve
RY9212001CAS0017US0
5-S12
CAUTION
• To discharge excess refrigerant, loosen the manifold's
gauge's low-pressure valve and slow discharge it.
(1) Low pressure side (2) High pressure side
RY9212001CAS0020US0
5-S13
CAUTION
• If you fail to vacuum out a refrigerant cycle like that
mentioned above and simply charge the cycle with
refrigerant, the problem may recur.
(1) Low pressure side (2) High pressure side
RY9212001CAS0021US0
Moisture mixed into the cycle
1. Symptoms that appear in the refrigerant cycle
• At first the AC works normally, but after some time, the
pressure on the low-pressure side (1) becomes a vacuum
and the high-pressure side (2) is at a low pressure.
Low-pressure side (1) : Vacuum; High-pressure side (2) :
0.69 to 0.98 MPa (7 to 10 kgf/cm2, 99.6 to 142.2 psi)
2. Possible Causes
• Moisture in the refrigerant cycle freezes up in the expansion
valve orifice, creating a temporary blockage. As time
elapses, the ice thaws and it returns to normal.
3. Solution Methods
• Replace the receiver.
• Eliminate the moisture in the refrigerant cycle by repeatedly
vacuuming it out.
• Recharge the system with an appropriate amount of
refrigerant.
(1) Low pressure side (2) High pressure side
RY9212001CAS0022US0
5-S14
CAUTION
• When the compressor is producing a faulty compression, it
can be detected with a manifold gauge (figure at left).
(1) Low pressure side (2) High pressure side
RY9212001CAS0025US0
5-S15
CAUTION
• When removing the charge valve hose, cover it with a rag
to protect your fingers and eyes from frost bite from the
refrigerant.
(1) Refrigerant charging hose (5) Manifold gauge
(blue or yellow) (6) Low-pressure side charge valve
(2) Refrigerant charging hose (red) (7) High-pressure side charge valve
(3) High-pressure valve
(4) Low-pressure valve
RY9212001CAS0027US0
RY9212001CAS0028US0
5-S16
5-S17
CAUTION
• Important : do not start the engine. If the engine is running,
the gas will flow back and burst either the service canister
or a hose.
IMPORTANT
• Do not open the low-pressure valve of the manifold gauge.
• If the service canister has been changed, be sure to expel
any air out of the charging hose (green).
1. Without starting the engine, open the high-pressure valve and
charge with about 500g of gas.
2. While charging, once the low-pressure gauge indicates about
0.10 MPa (about 1 kgf/cm2), close the high-pressure valve and
the service canister valve for the time being.
3. Use a gas detector to check the hoses and pipe connections for
gas leaks; if any exist, repair them. If there are no leaks,
continue charging the refrigerant.
4. When charging on the high-pressure side stops, close the
high-pressure valve on the manifold gauge and the service
canister valve, and then charge from the low-pressure side.
(1) Service canister valve (a) Press valve core to expel air
(2) High-pressure valve
(3) Low-pressure valve
RY9212001CAS0031US0
CAUTION
• Never open the manifold gauge's high-pressure valve when
charging refrigerant while the engine is running. (If the
high-pressure valve is opened, high-pressure gas will flow
back up the line and rupture the service canister or a
charging hose.)
• Always keep the service canister upright when charging.
IMPORTANT
• If the service canister has been changed, be sure to expel
any air out of the charging hose (green).
1. Check and make sure the manifold gauge's high-pressure valve
is closed.
2. After starting the engine, set it to about 1,500 rpms and open all
of the doors.
3. Turn the AC switch on and set the temperature control to
maximum cooling.
4. Open the manifold gauge's low-pressure valve and the service
canister valve and charge with the specified amount of gas.
5. After completing refrigerant charging, close the manifold
gauge's low-pressure valve and the service canister valve and
stop the engine.
6. Check for any gas leaks with the gas leak tester.
RY9212001CAS0032US0
5-S18
5-S19
Criteria
No air bubbles at all in the flow. In this case, both high
(a) Overcharged and low-pressure sides are at high pressure and the
cooling is ineffective.
Almost no air bubbles in the flow. If the engine rpm is
Normal
(b) raised gradually from idle to 1,500 rpm, the air bubbles
amount
disappear and the flow becomes transparent.
(c) Undercharged Air bubbles flow past constantly.
5-S20
(2) Relays
After turning the starter switch off, remove the cover under the
seat, remove each relay and take the following measurements.
(1) Fuse box (A) Blower motor relay
(B) Compressor clutch relay
(C) Cab relay
(D) Cab work light relay
RY9212001CAS0037US0
5-S21
5-S22
5-S23
5-S24
5-S25
5-S26
5-S27
(1) Top case (9) Expansion valve (17) Clip (25) Cap (plug)
(2) Evaporator (10) Expansion bolt (18) Washer screw (26) Blower fan
(3) Bottom case (11) Thermistor ASSY (19) O-ring (27) Wire harness
(4) Linkage cover (12) Thermistor clamp (20) Servo motor (28) AC collar
(5) Intake cover (13) AC amp (21) Linkage lever (29) Flat washer
(6) Evaporator (14) Heater Core (22) Blower resistor (30) Bolt
(7) O-ring (15) Pipe (23) Tapping screw (31) Air Conditioning Unit
(8) O-ring (16) Water valve (24) Tapping screw
RY9212001CAS0050US0
5-S28
(When removing)
1. Collect the refrigerant from the AC system.
2. Disconnect the negative (–) cable from the battery and the 1P connector of the magnetic clutch.
3. Remove the AC hoses.
CAUTION
• After removing hoses, immediately seal the AC system so no moisture or water gets into it.
(When attaching)
• Pay attention to whether each hose is for high or low pressure.
• Pay attention to whether each hose is an inlet or outlet hose.
• Attach each bolt and tighten to its specified torque.
• Tighten the nuts for aluminum pipe with two wrenches, holding one side from turning and tightening the nut to it.
(The mating side is soft, so be careful when tightening.)
• Tighten carefully so the pipe does not turn.
• Apply some compressor oil to pipes that have O-rings and press the tip into the stepped surface.
RY9212001CAS0051US0
5-S29
5-S30
[NOTE]
Shim Thickness Part No.
0.10 mm (0.0039 in.) T1065-87340
0.15 mm (0.0059 in) T1065-87350
0.30 mm (0.012 in.) T2055-87410
0.40 mm (0.016 in.) T1065-87360
0.50 mm (0.020 in.) T2055-87420
0.60 mm (0.024 in.) T1065-87370
1.0 mm (0.0394 in.) T1065-87380
5-S31
5-S32
(When removing)
1. Remove the receiver and its bracket (receiver).
2. Remove the plate (condenser) from the bracket (oil cooler).
3. After removing the plate (condenser) and the cushion
(condenser), remove the condenser.
CAUTION
• The receiver has a desiccant in it, so do not remove its
rubber cap until just before connecting its hoses. Be
careful not to damage the fins of the condenser.
(When attaching)
• Be careful of the orientation of the thrust collar (condenser)
when installing it.
• Be careful not to mistake an inlet hose for an outlet hose.
• Attach each bolt and tighten to its specified torque.
NOTE
Part Replaced Fill Capacity Brand Name
40 cc
Condenser
0.04 U.S.qts
40 cc
Evaporator
0.04 U.S.qts
ND-OIL8 <PAG* oil>
10 cc
Receiver
0.01 U.S.qts
20 cc
Hose
0.02 U.S.qts
5-S33
5-S34
5-S35
5-S36
(When Attaching)
• (A) Insert the filters in the clearance of upper and lower of the
duct. (the filter's convex surface is at the cover side)
• (B) Insert the nail part of left edge of the cover into the slit part
and push the right edge to the spring plate until it hooks.
• (C) Tighten the cover with the duct and the knob bolt.
1. Insert and attach the duct assy (3, air-intake, A/C) into the duct
assy (air-intake, base) and the bracket.
2. Insert and attach the duct assy (1, air-intake, A/C) into the A/C
unit.
3. Insert and attach the duct (2, air-intake, A/C) into duct assy (1,
air-intake, A/C) and duct assy (air-intake, base).
(1) Knob bolt (7) Duct ASSY (2, air-intake, A/C)
(2) Cover (8) Duct ASSY (air-intake, base)
(3) Duct (9) Duct ASSY (3, air-intake, A/C)
(4) Filter (10) Bracket (air-intake, duct)
(5) Spring plate (11) Duct cover
(6) Duct ASSY (1, air-intake, A/C) (12) Switch cover
RY9212032CAS0002US0
5-S37
6. Remove the floor mat and the two nuts (1) at the front of the
machine to attach the cabin.
107 to 127.4 N·m
Tightening torque Nut (1) 11.0 to 13.0 kgf·m
79.69 to 92.6 lbf·ft
(1) Nut
RY9212032CAS0006US0
7. Remove the two nuts (1) at the rear of the machine to attach the
cabin.
107 to 127.4 N·m
Tightening torque Nut (1) 11.0 to 13.0 kgf·m
79.69 to 92.6 lbf·ft
(1) Nut
RY9212032CAS0007US0
5-S38
78 to 127 N·m
Stud (front) (6)
Tightening torque 8.0 to 13.0 kgf·m
Stud (rear) (7)
58 to 94 lbf·ft
5-S39
8. WINDOW WASHER
[1] WIPER SWITCH
Connector voltage
1. Remove the 6P connector from the wiper switch.
2. Switch the starter switch to [RUN] and the wiper switch to ON.
3. Measure the voltage between terminal 1of the connector on the
harness side and ground on the body.
4. If is the same as the battery voltage (DC 11 to 14 V), it is normal.
(1) Wiper switch A : 6P connector (harness side)
RY9212001CAS0071US0
5-S40
The wiper is installed on the front and is composed of a wiper motor, wiper arm, wiper blade, etc.
RY9212001CAS0074US0
5-S41
Connector voltage
1. Remove the 2P connector from the washer motor.
2. Press in on the [OFF] side of the wiper switch. (so only the
window washer operates)
3. Measure the voltage between terminals 1 and 2 of the
connector on the harness side.
4. If is the same as the battery voltage (DC 11 to 14V), the
connector voltage is normal.
A : 2P connector (harness side)
RY9212001CAS0078US0
5-S42
Connector voltage
1. Disconnect the cab power 8P connector from the wire harness
(cabin).
2. Measure the voltage between terminal 3 of the connector on the
cabin power harness side and ground on the body. (interior
light)
3. Turn the starter switch to [RUN].
4. Measure the voltage between terminal 4 of the connector on the
cabin power harness side and ground on the body. (cab work
light)
5. If is the same as the battery voltage (DC 11 to 14 V), the
connector voltage is normal.
(1) Cab power harness A : 8P connector
(cab power harness side)
B : 8P connector
(cab harness side)
RY9212001CAS0080US0
5-S43
5-S44
5-S45
CAUTION
• If the piano wire gets very hot in one place, it may break.
Avoid rubbing it with much force against the edge of the
glass.
• Be careful not to cut yourself on fragments of glass or the
blade of the cutter.
(1) Cab frame (5) Piano wire
(2) Glass (6) Wood
(3) Awl (7) Adhesive cutter
(4) Adhesive
RY9212001CAS0086US0
5-S46
5-S47
5-S48
4. Remove the lock of the front window (top) and loosen the lock's
mounting bolts.
5. Leave the rear bolt as is and lift up the front bolt 1.0 to 1.5 mm
(0.04 to 0.06 in.).
NOTE
• Lifting the bolt more than 1.5 mm (0.06 in.) may prevent the
lock from working.
6. Re-tighten the bolts to the specified torque.
7. Close the front window (top) and lock it securely.
8. Recheck the clearance between the glass and the cab frame
and make sure the clearance is smaller.
9. Operate the mini-excavator and make sure the rattling has
stopped while driving.
10. Spray some water on the window and make sure it does not
leak.
(1) Lock (3) Bolt (rear)
(2) Bolt (front)
RY9212001CAS0093US0
5-S49
5-S50